bfd/
[binutils.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
blobb804eeaf059050f2e1dc4b28ec583774c039d40c
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6 <ian@cygnus.com>.
7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8 <mark@codesourcery.com>
9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
17 (at your option) any later version.
19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
22 GNU General Public License for more details.
24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
27 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
30 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
32 #include "sysdep.h"
33 #include "bfd.h"
34 #include "libbfd.h"
35 #include "libiberty.h"
36 #include "elf-bfd.h"
37 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
38 #include "elf/mips.h"
39 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
41 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
42 #include "coff/sym.h"
43 #include "coff/symconst.h"
44 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
45 #include "coff/mips.h"
47 #include "hashtab.h"
49 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
50 There are three types of entry:
52 (1) absolute addresses
53 (abfd == NULL)
54 (2) SYMBOL + OFFSET addresses, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
55 (abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0)
56 (3) SYMBOL addresses, where SYMBOL is not local to an input bfd
57 (abfd != NULL, symndx == -1)
59 Type (3) entries are treated differently for different types of GOT.
60 In the "master" GOT -- i.e. the one that describes every GOT
61 reference needed in the link -- the mips_got_entry is keyed on both
62 the symbol and the input bfd that references it. If it turns out
63 that we need multiple GOTs, we can then use this information to
64 create separate GOTs for each input bfd.
66 However, we want each of these separate GOTs to have at most one
67 entry for a given symbol, so their type (3) entries are keyed only
68 on the symbol. The input bfd given by the "abfd" field is somewhat
69 arbitrary in this case.
71 This means that when there are multiple GOTs, each GOT has a unique
72 mips_got_entry for every symbol within it. We can therefore use the
73 mips_got_entry fields (tls_type and gotidx) to track the symbol's
74 GOT index.
76 However, if it turns out that we need only a single GOT, we continue
77 to use the master GOT to describe it. There may therefore be several
78 mips_got_entries for the same symbol, each with a different input bfd.
79 We want to make sure that each symbol gets a unique GOT entry, so when
80 there's a single GOT, we use the symbol's hash entry, not the
81 mips_got_entry fields, to track a symbol's GOT index. */
82 struct mips_got_entry
84 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
85 bfd *abfd;
86 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
87 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
88 long symndx;
89 union
91 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
92 bfd_vma address;
93 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
94 that should be added to the symbol value. */
95 bfd_vma addend;
96 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
97 corresponding to symbol in the GOT. The symbol's entry
98 is in the local area if h->global_got_area is GGA_NONE,
99 otherwise it is in the global area. */
100 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
101 } d;
103 /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
104 IE). The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
105 relocations. LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
106 combined with any GD or IE flags. An LDM GOT entry will be
107 a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
108 unsigned char tls_type;
110 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
111 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
112 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
113 long gotidx;
116 /* This structure describes a range of addends: [MIN_ADDEND, MAX_ADDEND].
117 The structures form a non-overlapping list that is sorted by increasing
118 MIN_ADDEND. */
119 struct mips_got_page_range
121 struct mips_got_page_range *next;
122 bfd_signed_vma min_addend;
123 bfd_signed_vma max_addend;
126 /* This structure describes the range of addends that are applied to page
127 relocations against a given symbol. */
128 struct mips_got_page_entry
130 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
131 bfd *abfd;
132 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info. */
133 long symndx;
134 /* The ranges for this page entry. */
135 struct mips_got_page_range *ranges;
136 /* The maximum number of page entries needed for RANGES. */
137 bfd_vma num_pages;
140 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
142 struct mips_got_info
144 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
145 symbol table. */
146 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
147 /* The number of global .got entries. */
148 unsigned int global_gotno;
149 /* The number of global .got entries that are in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area. */
150 unsigned int reloc_only_gotno;
151 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
152 unsigned int tls_gotno;
153 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
154 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
155 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
156 /* The number of local .got entries, eventually including page entries. */
157 unsigned int local_gotno;
158 /* The maximum number of page entries needed. */
159 unsigned int page_gotno;
160 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
161 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
162 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
163 struct htab *got_entries;
164 /* A hash table of mips_got_page_entry structures. */
165 struct htab *got_page_entries;
166 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
167 unless multi-got was necessary. */
168 struct htab *bfd2got;
169 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
170 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
171 struct mips_got_info *next;
172 /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
173 for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned. This is needed
174 because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
175 for the LDM. It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode. */
176 bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
179 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
181 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash
183 bfd *bfd;
184 struct mips_got_info *g;
187 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
188 create and merge bfd's gots. */
190 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
192 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
193 htab_t bfd2got;
194 /* The output bfd. */
195 bfd *obfd;
196 /* The link information. */
197 struct bfd_link_info *info;
198 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
199 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
200 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
201 struct mips_got_info *primary;
202 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
203 gots. */
204 struct mips_got_info *current;
205 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
206 16-bit offset. */
207 unsigned int max_count;
208 /* The maximum number of page entries needed by each got. */
209 unsigned int max_pages;
210 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
211 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
212 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
213 the "master" GOT. */
214 unsigned int global_count;
217 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
219 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
221 struct mips_got_info *g;
222 int value;
223 unsigned int needed_relocs;
224 struct bfd_link_info *info;
227 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
228 entry or ELF symbol table traversal. */
230 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
232 struct bfd_link_info *info;
233 unsigned int needed;
236 struct _mips_elf_section_data
238 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
239 union
241 bfd_byte *tdata;
242 } u;
245 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
246 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
248 #define is_mips_elf(bfd) \
249 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
250 && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
251 && elf_object_id (bfd) == MIPS_ELF_DATA)
253 /* The ABI says that every symbol used by dynamic relocations must have
254 a global GOT entry. Among other things, this provides the dynamic
255 linker with a free, directly-indexed cache. The GOT can therefore
256 contain symbols that are not referenced by GOT relocations themselves
257 (in other words, it may have symbols that are not referenced by things
258 like R_MIPS_GOT16 and R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE).
260 GOT relocations are less likely to overflow if we put the associated
261 GOT entries towards the beginning. We therefore divide the global
262 GOT entries into two areas: "normal" and "reloc-only". Entries in
263 the first area can be used for both dynamic relocations and GP-relative
264 accesses, while those in the "reloc-only" area are for dynamic
265 relocations only.
267 These GGA_* ("Global GOT Area") values are organised so that lower
268 values are more general than higher values. Also, non-GGA_NONE
269 values are ordered by the position of the area in the GOT. */
270 #define GGA_NORMAL 0
271 #define GGA_RELOC_ONLY 1
272 #define GGA_NONE 2
274 /* Information about a non-PIC interface to a PIC function. There are
275 two ways of creating these interfaces. The first is to add:
277 lui $25,%hi(func)
278 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
280 immediately before a PIC function "func". The second is to add:
282 lui $25,%hi(func)
283 j func
284 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
286 to a separate trampoline section.
288 Stubs of the first kind go in a new section immediately before the
289 target function. Stubs of the second kind go in a single section
290 pointed to by the hash table's "strampoline" field. */
291 struct mips_elf_la25_stub {
292 /* The generated section that contains this stub. */
293 asection *stub_section;
295 /* The offset of the stub from the start of STUB_SECTION. */
296 bfd_vma offset;
298 /* One symbol for the original function. Its location is available
299 in H->root.root.u.def. */
300 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
303 /* Macros for populating a mips_elf_la25_stub. */
305 #define LA25_LUI(VAL) (0x3c190000 | (VAL)) /* lui t9,VAL */
306 #define LA25_J(VAL) (0x08000000 | (((VAL) >> 2) & 0x3ffffff)) /* j VAL */
307 #define LA25_ADDIU(VAL) (0x27390000 | (VAL)) /* addiu t9,t9,VAL */
309 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
310 the dynamic symbols. */
312 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
314 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
315 index. */
316 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
317 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
318 symbol with a GOT entry. */
319 long min_got_dynindx;
320 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
321 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
322 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
323 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
324 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
325 symbol without a GOT entry. */
326 long max_non_got_dynindx;
329 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
330 the global hash table. */
332 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
334 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
336 /* External symbol information. */
337 EXTR esym;
339 /* The la25 stub we have created for ths symbol, if any. */
340 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *la25_stub;
342 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
343 this symbol. */
344 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
346 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
347 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
348 asection *fn_stub;
350 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
351 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
352 asection *call_stub;
354 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
355 being called returns a floating point value. */
356 asection *call_fp_stub;
358 #define GOT_NORMAL 0
359 #define GOT_TLS_GD 1
360 #define GOT_TLS_LDM 2
361 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4
362 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE 0x40
363 #define GOT_TLS_DONE 0x80
364 unsigned char tls_type;
366 /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
367 is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
368 there. In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
369 structures all referring to the same GOT slot. It might be
370 possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
371 overloaded already. */
372 bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
374 /* The highest GGA_* value that satisfies all references to this symbol. */
375 unsigned int global_got_area : 2;
377 /* True if all GOT relocations against this symbol are for calls. This is
378 a looser condition than no_fn_stub below, because there may be other
379 non-call non-GOT relocations against the symbol. */
380 unsigned int got_only_for_calls : 1;
382 /* True if one of the relocations described by possibly_dynamic_relocs
383 is against a readonly section. */
384 unsigned int readonly_reloc : 1;
386 /* True if there is a relocation against this symbol that must be
387 resolved by the static linker (in other words, if the relocation
388 cannot possibly be made dynamic). */
389 unsigned int has_static_relocs : 1;
391 /* True if we must not create a .MIPS.stubs entry for this symbol.
392 This is set, for example, if there are relocations related to
393 taking the function's address, i.e. any but R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones.
394 See "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition", p. 4-20. */
395 unsigned int no_fn_stub : 1;
397 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is true if this symbol appears
398 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
399 unsigned int need_fn_stub : 1;
401 /* True if this symbol is referenced by branch relocations from
402 any non-PIC input file. This is used to determine whether an
403 la25 stub is required. */
404 unsigned int has_nonpic_branches : 1;
406 /* Does this symbol need a traditional MIPS lazy-binding stub
407 (as opposed to a PLT entry)? */
408 unsigned int needs_lazy_stub : 1;
411 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
413 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
415 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
416 #if 0
417 /* We no longer use this. */
418 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
419 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
420 #endif
422 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
423 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
425 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
426 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
428 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
429 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
430 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
432 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
433 bfd_vma rld_value;
435 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
436 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
438 /* True if we can generate copy relocs and PLTs. */
439 bfd_boolean use_plts_and_copy_relocs;
441 /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks. */
442 bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
444 /* True if we already reported the small-data section overflow. */
445 bfd_boolean small_data_overflow_reported;
447 /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
448 being used. */
449 asection *srelbss;
450 asection *sdynbss;
451 asection *srelplt;
452 asection *srelplt2;
453 asection *sgotplt;
454 asection *splt;
455 asection *sstubs;
456 asection *sgot;
458 /* The master GOT information. */
459 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
461 /* The size of the PLT header in bytes. */
462 bfd_vma plt_header_size;
464 /* The size of a PLT entry in bytes. */
465 bfd_vma plt_entry_size;
467 /* The number of functions that need a lazy-binding stub. */
468 bfd_vma lazy_stub_count;
470 /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes. */
471 bfd_vma function_stub_size;
473 /* The number of reserved entries at the beginning of the GOT. */
474 unsigned int reserved_gotno;
476 /* The section used for mips_elf_la25_stub trampolines.
477 See the comment above that structure for details. */
478 asection *strampoline;
480 /* A table of mips_elf_la25_stubs, indexed by (input_section, offset)
481 pairs. */
482 htab_t la25_stubs;
484 /* A function FN (NAME, IS, OS) that creates a new input section
485 called NAME and links it to output section OS. If IS is nonnull,
486 the new section should go immediately before it, otherwise it
487 should go at the (current) beginning of OS.
489 The function returns the new section on success, otherwise it
490 returns null. */
491 asection *(*add_stub_section) (const char *, asection *, asection *);
494 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
496 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
497 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
498 == MIPS_ELF_DATA ? ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
500 /* A structure used to communicate with htab_traverse callbacks. */
501 struct mips_htab_traverse_info
503 /* The usual link-wide information. */
504 struct bfd_link_info *info;
505 bfd *output_bfd;
507 /* Starts off FALSE and is set to TRUE if the link should be aborted. */
508 bfd_boolean error;
511 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
512 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
513 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
514 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
515 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
516 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
517 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
518 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
519 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
520 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
521 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
522 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
523 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
524 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
526 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
528 struct extsym_info
530 bfd *abfd;
531 struct bfd_link_info *info;
532 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
533 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
534 bfd_boolean failed;
537 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
539 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
541 "_procedure_table",
542 "_procedure_string_table",
543 "_procedure_table_size",
544 NULL
547 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
548 IRIX5. */
550 typedef struct
552 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
553 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
554 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
555 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
556 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
557 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
558 } Elf32_compact_rel;
560 typedef struct
562 bfd_byte id1[4];
563 bfd_byte num[4];
564 bfd_byte id2[4];
565 bfd_byte offset[4];
566 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
567 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
568 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
570 typedef struct
572 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
573 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
574 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
575 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
576 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
577 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
578 } Elf32_crinfo;
580 typedef struct
582 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
583 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
584 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
585 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
586 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
587 } Elf32_crinfo2;
589 typedef struct
591 bfd_byte info[4];
592 bfd_byte konst[4];
593 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
594 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
596 typedef struct
598 bfd_byte info[4];
599 bfd_byte konst[4];
600 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
602 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
604 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
605 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
606 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
607 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
608 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
609 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
610 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
611 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
613 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
614 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
615 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
616 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
617 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
619 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
620 has different meaning for each type:
622 (type) (konst)
623 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
624 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
625 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
626 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
629 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
630 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
631 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
632 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
634 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
635 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
636 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
637 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
639 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
640 loader for use by the static exception system. */
642 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
643 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
644 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
645 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
646 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
647 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
648 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
649 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
650 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
651 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
652 long reserved;
653 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
654 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
655 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
656 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
658 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
659 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, bfd_vma, unsigned long,
660 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
661 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
662 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
663 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
664 (bfd_vma);
665 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
666 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
667 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
668 bfd_vma *, asection *);
669 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
670 (const void *);
671 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
672 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
673 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
674 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
676 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
677 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
679 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs with load interlocking that include
680 non-MIPS1 CPUs and R3900. */
681 #define LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P(abfd) \
682 ( ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) != E_MIPS_ARCH_1) \
683 || ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_3900))
685 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JAL is converted to BAL.
686 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate
687 for RM9000 for now. */
688 #define JAL_TO_BAL_P(abfd) \
689 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_9000)
691 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JALR is converted to BAL.
692 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
693 all CPUs. */
694 #define JALR_TO_BAL_P(abfd) 1
696 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JR is converted to B.
697 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
698 all CPUs. */
699 #define JR_TO_B_P(abfd) 1
701 /* True if ABFD is a PIC object. */
702 #define PIC_OBJECT_P(abfd) \
703 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC) != 0)
705 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
706 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
707 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
709 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
710 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
711 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
713 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
714 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
716 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
717 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
718 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
720 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
721 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
722 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
724 /* The name of the options section. */
725 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
726 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
728 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
729 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
730 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
731 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
733 /* Whether the section is readonly. */
734 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
735 ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)) \
736 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
738 /* The name of the stub section. */
739 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
741 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
742 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
743 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
745 /* The size of an external RELA relocation. */
746 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
747 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
749 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
750 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
751 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
753 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
754 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
755 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
757 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
758 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
759 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
761 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
762 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
763 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
765 /* Get word-sized data. */
766 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
767 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
769 /* Put out word-sized data. */
770 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
771 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
772 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
773 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
775 /* The opcode for word-sized loads (LW or LD). */
776 #define MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD(abfd) \
777 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 0xdc000000 : 0x8c000000)
779 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
780 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
781 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
783 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
784 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
786 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section. */
787 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
788 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
790 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
791 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
792 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
793 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
795 /* The value to write into got[1] for SVR4 targets, to identify it is
796 a GNU object. The dynamic linker can then use got[1] to store the
797 module pointer. */
798 #define MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK(abfd) \
799 ((bfd_vma) 1 << (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 63 : 31))
801 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
802 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
803 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
805 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
806 offsets from $gp. */
807 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
809 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
810 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
811 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
812 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
813 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
814 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
815 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
816 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
817 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
818 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
819 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
820 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
821 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
822 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL) \
823 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
824 ? (0x64180000 + (VAL)) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
825 : (0x24180000 + (VAL)))) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
827 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
828 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
830 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
831 section. */
833 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
834 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
835 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
836 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
838 #ifdef BFD64
839 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
840 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
841 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
842 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
843 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
844 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
845 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
846 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
847 #else
848 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
849 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
850 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
851 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
852 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
853 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
854 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
855 #endif
857 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
858 floating point arguments.
860 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
861 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
862 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
863 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
864 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
865 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
866 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
867 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
869 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
870 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
871 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
872 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
873 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
874 stub should be discarded.
876 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
877 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
878 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
879 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
880 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
881 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
882 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
883 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
885 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
886 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
887 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
889 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
891 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
892 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
893 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
895 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
896 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
897 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
899 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an O32 executable. */
900 static const bfd_vma mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
902 0x3c1c0000, /* lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
903 0x8f990000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28) */
904 0x279c0000, /* addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
905 0x031cc023, /* subu $24, $24, $28 */
906 0x03e07821, /* move $15, $31 */
907 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
908 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
909 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
912 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N32 executable. Different
913 because gp ($28) is not available; we use t2 ($14) instead. */
914 static const bfd_vma mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
916 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
917 0x8dd90000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
918 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
919 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
920 0x03e07821, /* move $15, $31 */
921 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
922 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
923 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
926 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N64 executable. Different
927 from N32 because of the increased size of GOT entries. */
928 static const bfd_vma mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry[] =
930 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
931 0xddd90000, /* ld $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
932 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
933 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
934 0x03e07821, /* move $15, $31 */
935 0x0018c0c2, /* srl $24, $24, 3 */
936 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
937 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
940 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
941 static const bfd_vma mips_exec_plt_entry[] =
943 0x3c0f0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
944 0x01f90000, /* l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
945 0x25f80000, /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
946 0x03200008 /* jr $25 */
949 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable. */
950 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] =
952 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
953 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
954 0x8f390008, /* lw t9, 8(t9) */
955 0x00000000, /* nop */
956 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
957 0x00000000 /* nop */
960 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
961 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] =
963 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
964 0x24180000, /* li t8, <pltindex> */
965 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>) */
966 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>) */
967 0x8f390000, /* lw t9, 0(t9) */
968 0x00000000, /* nop */
969 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
970 0x00000000 /* nop */
973 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object. */
974 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] =
976 0x8f990008, /* lw t9, 8(gp) */
977 0x00000000, /* nop */
978 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
979 0x00000000, /* nop */
980 0x00000000, /* nop */
981 0x00000000 /* nop */
984 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
985 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] =
987 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
988 0x24180000 /* li t8, <pltindex> */
991 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
993 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
994 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
995 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
996 (copy), (follow)))
998 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1000 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
1001 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
1002 (&(table)->root, \
1003 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
1004 (info)))
1006 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
1007 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
1009 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
1010 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
1012 static bfd_vma
1013 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1015 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1016 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1017 return 0;
1018 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
1021 static bfd_vma
1022 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1024 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1025 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1026 return 0;
1027 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
1030 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1032 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
1033 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
1034 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
1036 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
1037 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
1039 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
1040 subclass. */
1041 if (ret == NULL)
1042 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
1043 if (ret == NULL)
1044 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1046 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
1047 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
1048 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
1049 table, string));
1050 if (ret != NULL)
1052 /* Set local fields. */
1053 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
1054 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
1055 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
1056 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
1057 ret->la25_stub = 0;
1058 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
1059 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
1060 ret->call_stub = NULL;
1061 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
1062 ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1063 ret->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
1064 ret->got_only_for_calls = TRUE;
1065 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
1066 ret->has_static_relocs = FALSE;
1067 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
1068 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
1069 ret->has_nonpic_branches = FALSE;
1070 ret->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
1073 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1076 bfd_boolean
1077 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1079 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
1081 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
1082 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
1084 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1085 if (sdata == NULL)
1086 return FALSE;
1087 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
1090 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
1093 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
1094 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
1096 bfd_boolean
1097 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
1098 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1100 HDRR *symhdr;
1101 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1102 char *ext_hdr;
1104 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1105 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
1107 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
1108 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
1109 goto error_return;
1111 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
1112 swap->external_hdr_size))
1113 goto error_return;
1115 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1116 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
1118 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
1119 read. */
1120 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
1121 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
1122 debug->ptr = NULL; \
1123 else \
1125 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
1126 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
1127 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
1128 goto error_return; \
1129 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
1130 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
1131 goto error_return; \
1134 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
1135 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
1136 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
1137 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
1138 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
1139 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
1140 union aux_ext *);
1141 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1142 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1143 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
1144 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
1145 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
1146 #undef READ
1148 debug->fdr = NULL;
1150 return TRUE;
1152 error_return:
1153 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
1154 free (ext_hdr);
1155 if (debug->line != NULL)
1156 free (debug->line);
1157 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
1158 free (debug->external_dnr);
1159 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
1160 free (debug->external_pdr);
1161 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
1162 free (debug->external_sym);
1163 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
1164 free (debug->external_opt);
1165 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
1166 free (debug->external_aux);
1167 if (debug->ss != NULL)
1168 free (debug->ss);
1169 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
1170 free (debug->ssext);
1171 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
1172 free (debug->external_fdr);
1173 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
1174 free (debug->external_rfd);
1175 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
1176 free (debug->external_ext);
1177 return FALSE;
1180 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
1182 static void
1183 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
1185 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
1186 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
1187 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
1188 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
1189 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
1190 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
1192 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
1193 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
1195 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
1198 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
1200 static bfd_boolean
1201 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
1202 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
1203 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1205 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1206 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1207 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
1208 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
1209 void *rtproc;
1210 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
1211 struct sym_ext *esym;
1212 char *ss, **sv;
1213 char *str;
1214 bfd_size_type size;
1215 bfd_size_type count;
1216 unsigned long sindex;
1217 unsigned long i;
1218 PDR pdr;
1219 SYMR sym;
1220 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
1222 epdr = NULL;
1223 rpdr = NULL;
1224 esym = NULL;
1225 ss = NULL;
1226 sv = NULL;
1228 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1230 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1231 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1232 if (count > 0)
1234 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1236 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1237 if (epdr == NULL)
1238 goto error_return;
1240 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1241 goto error_return;
1243 size = sizeof (RPDR);
1244 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1245 if (rpdr == NULL)
1246 goto error_return;
1248 size = sizeof (char *);
1249 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1250 if (sv == NULL)
1251 goto error_return;
1253 count = hdr->isymMax;
1254 size = swap->external_sym_size;
1255 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1256 if (esym == NULL)
1257 goto error_return;
1259 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1260 goto error_return;
1262 count = hdr->issMax;
1263 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1264 if (ss == NULL)
1265 goto error_return;
1266 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1267 goto error_return;
1269 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1270 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1272 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1273 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1274 rp->adr = sym.value;
1275 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1276 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1277 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1278 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1279 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1280 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1281 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1282 rp->irpss = sindex;
1283 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1284 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1288 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1289 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1290 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1291 if (rtproc == NULL)
1293 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1294 goto error_return;
1297 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1299 erp = rtproc;
1300 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1301 erp++;
1302 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1303 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1304 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1305 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1307 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1308 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1309 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1311 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1313 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
1314 s->size = size;
1315 s->contents = rtproc;
1317 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1318 matters, but someday it might). */
1319 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1321 if (epdr != NULL)
1322 free (epdr);
1323 if (rpdr != NULL)
1324 free (rpdr);
1325 if (esym != NULL)
1326 free (esym);
1327 if (ss != NULL)
1328 free (ss);
1329 if (sv != NULL)
1330 free (sv);
1332 return TRUE;
1334 error_return:
1335 if (epdr != NULL)
1336 free (epdr);
1337 if (rpdr != NULL)
1338 free (rpdr);
1339 if (esym != NULL)
1340 free (esym);
1341 if (ss != NULL)
1342 free (ss);
1343 if (sv != NULL)
1344 free (sv);
1345 return FALSE;
1348 /* We're going to create a stub for H. Create a symbol for the stub's
1349 value and size, to help make the disassembly easier to read. */
1351 static bfd_boolean
1352 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1353 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1354 const char *prefix, asection *s, bfd_vma value,
1355 bfd_vma size)
1357 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1358 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1359 const char *name;
1361 /* Create a new symbol. */
1362 name = ACONCAT ((prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL));
1363 bh = NULL;
1364 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1365 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1366 TRUE, FALSE, &bh))
1367 return FALSE;
1369 /* Make it a local function. */
1370 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1371 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
1372 elfh->size = size;
1373 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1374 return TRUE;
1377 /* We're about to redefine H. Create a symbol to represent H's
1378 current value and size, to help make the disassembly easier
1379 to read. */
1381 static bfd_boolean
1382 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1383 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1384 const char *prefix)
1386 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1387 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1388 const char *name;
1389 asection *s;
1390 bfd_vma value;
1392 /* Read the symbol's value. */
1393 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1394 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
1395 s = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1396 value = h->root.root.u.def.value;
1398 /* Create a new symbol. */
1399 name = ACONCAT ((prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL));
1400 bh = NULL;
1401 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1402 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1403 TRUE, FALSE, &bh))
1404 return FALSE;
1406 /* Make it local and copy the other attributes from H. */
1407 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1408 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, ELF_ST_TYPE (h->root.type));
1409 elfh->other = h->root.other;
1410 elfh->size = h->root.size;
1411 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1412 return TRUE;
1415 /* Return TRUE if relocations in SECTION can refer directly to a MIPS16
1416 function rather than to a hard-float stub. */
1418 static bfd_boolean
1419 section_allows_mips16_refs_p (asection *section)
1421 const char *name;
1423 name = bfd_get_section_name (section->owner, section);
1424 return (FN_STUB_P (name)
1425 || CALL_STUB_P (name)
1426 || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name)
1427 || strcmp (name, ".pdr") == 0);
1430 /* [RELOCS, RELEND) are the relocations against SEC, which is a MIPS16
1431 stub section of some kind. Return the R_SYMNDX of the target
1432 function, or 0 if we can't decide which function that is. */
1434 static unsigned long
1435 mips16_stub_symndx (asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1436 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
1437 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
1439 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
1441 /* Trust the first R_MIPS_NONE relocation, if any. */
1442 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
1443 if (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info) == R_MIPS_NONE)
1444 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, rel->r_info);
1446 /* Otherwise trust the first relocation, whatever its kind. This is
1447 the traditional behavior. */
1448 if (relocs < relend)
1449 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, relocs->r_info);
1451 return 0;
1454 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1455 discard them. */
1457 static void
1458 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1459 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1461 /* Dynamic symbols must use the standard call interface, in case other
1462 objects try to call them. */
1463 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1464 && h->root.dynindx != -1)
1466 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (info, h, ".mips16.");
1467 h->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
1470 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1471 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1473 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1474 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1475 being included in the link. */
1476 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1477 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1478 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1479 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1482 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1483 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1485 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1486 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1487 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1488 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1489 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1490 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1491 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1494 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1495 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1497 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1498 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1499 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1500 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1501 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1502 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1503 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1507 /* Hashtable callbacks for mips_elf_la25_stubs. */
1509 static hashval_t
1510 mips_elf_la25_stub_hash (const void *entry_)
1512 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry;
1514 entry = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry_;
1515 return entry->h->root.root.u.def.section->id
1516 + entry->h->root.root.u.def.value;
1519 static int
1520 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
1522 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry1, *entry2;
1524 entry1 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry1_;
1525 entry2 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry2_;
1526 return ((entry1->h->root.root.u.def.section
1527 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.section)
1528 && (entry1->h->root.root.u.def.value
1529 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.value));
1532 /* Called by the linker to set up the la25 stub-creation code. FN is
1533 the linker's implementation of add_stub_function. Return true on
1534 success. */
1536 bfd_boolean
1537 _bfd_mips_elf_init_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1538 asection *(*fn) (const char *, asection *,
1539 asection *))
1541 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1543 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1544 if (htab == NULL)
1545 return FALSE;
1547 htab->add_stub_section = fn;
1548 htab->la25_stubs = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_la25_stub_hash,
1549 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq, NULL);
1550 if (htab->la25_stubs == NULL)
1551 return FALSE;
1553 return TRUE;
1556 /* Return true if H is a locally-defined PIC function, in the sense
1557 that it might need $25 to be valid on entry. Note that MIPS16
1558 functions never need $25 to be valid on entry; they set up $gp
1559 using PC-relative instructions instead. */
1561 static bfd_boolean
1562 mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1564 return ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1565 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1566 && h->root.def_regular
1567 && !bfd_is_abs_section (h->root.root.u.def.section)
1568 && !ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other)
1569 && (PIC_OBJECT_P (h->root.root.u.def.section->owner)
1570 || ELF_ST_IS_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other)));
1573 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1574 by inserting an LUI/ADDIU pair before the target function.
1575 Create the section and redirect the function symbol to it. */
1577 static bfd_boolean
1578 mips_elf_add_la25_intro (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1579 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1581 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1582 char *name;
1583 asection *s, *input_section;
1584 unsigned int align;
1586 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1587 if (htab == NULL)
1588 return FALSE;
1590 /* Create a unique name for the new section. */
1591 name = bfd_malloc (11 + sizeof (".text.stub."));
1592 if (name == NULL)
1593 return FALSE;
1594 sprintf (name, ".text.stub.%d", (int) htab_elements (htab->la25_stubs));
1596 /* Create the section. */
1597 input_section = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1598 s = htab->add_stub_section (name, input_section,
1599 input_section->output_section);
1600 if (s == NULL)
1601 return FALSE;
1603 /* Make sure that any padding goes before the stub. */
1604 align = input_section->alignment_power;
1605 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, align))
1606 return FALSE;
1607 if (align > 3)
1608 s->size = (1 << align) - 8;
1610 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1611 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 8);
1612 stub->stub_section = s;
1613 stub->offset = s->size;
1615 /* Allocate room for it. */
1616 s->size += 8;
1617 return TRUE;
1620 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1621 with a separate trampoline. Allocate room for it and redirect
1622 the function symbol to it. */
1624 static bfd_boolean
1625 mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1626 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1628 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1629 asection *s;
1631 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1632 if (htab == NULL)
1633 return FALSE;
1635 /* Create a trampoline section, if we haven't already. */
1636 s = htab->strampoline;
1637 if (s == NULL)
1639 asection *input_section = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1640 s = htab->add_stub_section (".text", NULL,
1641 input_section->output_section);
1642 if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, 4))
1643 return FALSE;
1644 htab->strampoline = s;
1647 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1648 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 16);
1649 stub->stub_section = s;
1650 stub->offset = s->size;
1652 /* Allocate room for it. */
1653 s->size += 16;
1654 return TRUE;
1657 /* H describes a symbol that needs an la25 stub. Make sure that an
1658 appropriate stub exists and point H at it. */
1660 static bfd_boolean
1661 mips_elf_add_la25_stub (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1662 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1664 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1665 struct mips_elf_la25_stub search, *stub;
1666 bfd_boolean use_trampoline_p;
1667 asection *s;
1668 bfd_vma value;
1669 void **slot;
1671 /* Prefer to use LUI/ADDIU stubs if the function is at the beginning
1672 of the section and if we would need no more than 2 nops. */
1673 s = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1674 value = h->root.root.u.def.value;
1675 use_trampoline_p = (value != 0 || s->alignment_power > 4);
1677 /* Describe the stub we want. */
1678 search.stub_section = NULL;
1679 search.offset = 0;
1680 search.h = h;
1682 /* See if we've already created an equivalent stub. */
1683 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1684 if (htab == NULL)
1685 return FALSE;
1687 slot = htab_find_slot (htab->la25_stubs, &search, INSERT);
1688 if (slot == NULL)
1689 return FALSE;
1691 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
1692 if (stub != NULL)
1694 /* We can reuse the existing stub. */
1695 h->la25_stub = stub;
1696 return TRUE;
1699 /* Create a permanent copy of ENTRY and add it to the hash table. */
1700 stub = bfd_malloc (sizeof (search));
1701 if (stub == NULL)
1702 return FALSE;
1703 *stub = search;
1704 *slot = stub;
1706 h->la25_stub = stub;
1707 return (use_trampoline_p
1708 ? mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (stub, info)
1709 : mips_elf_add_la25_intro (stub, info));
1712 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback that is called before sizing
1713 sections. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info structure. */
1715 static bfd_boolean
1716 mips_elf_check_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1718 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
1720 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
1721 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1722 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1724 if (!hti->info->relocatable)
1725 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (hti->info, h);
1727 if (mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (h))
1729 /* H is a function that might need $25 to be valid on entry.
1730 If we're creating a non-PIC relocatable object, mark H as
1731 being PIC. If we're creating a non-relocatable object with
1732 non-PIC branches and jumps to H, make sure that H has an la25
1733 stub. */
1734 if (hti->info->relocatable)
1736 if (!PIC_OBJECT_P (hti->output_bfd))
1737 h->root.other = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other);
1739 else if (h->has_nonpic_branches && !mips_elf_add_la25_stub (hti->info, h))
1741 hti->error = TRUE;
1742 return FALSE;
1745 return TRUE;
1748 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1749 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1750 are 32 bits.
1752 The format of these instructions is:
1754 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1755 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
1756 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1757 | Immediate 15:0 |
1758 +-----------------------------------------------+
1760 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1761 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1763 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1764 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
1765 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1766 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1767 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1768 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1769 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
1770 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1771 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1772 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1773 instruction.
1775 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1776 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
1777 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
1778 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1779 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1780 value as two 16-bit values.
1782 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1783 defined as
1785 big-endian:
1786 +--------+----------------------+
1787 | | |
1788 | | targ26-16 |
1789 |31 26|25 0|
1790 +--------+----------------------+
1792 little-endian:
1793 +----------+------+-------------+
1794 | | | |
1795 | sub1 | | sub2 |
1796 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
1797 +----------+--------------------+
1798 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1799 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1801 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1802 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1803 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1804 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1805 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1807 The table below lists the other MIPS16 instruction relocations.
1808 Each one is calculated in the same way as the non-MIPS16 relocation
1809 given on the right, but using the extended MIPS16 layout of 16-bit
1810 immediate fields:
1812 R_MIPS16_GPREL R_MIPS_GPREL16
1813 R_MIPS16_GOT16 R_MIPS_GOT16
1814 R_MIPS16_CALL16 R_MIPS_CALL16
1815 R_MIPS16_HI16 R_MIPS_HI16
1816 R_MIPS16_LO16 R_MIPS_LO16
1818 A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1820 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1821 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
1822 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1823 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
1824 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1826 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
1827 opcode.
1829 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately.
1830 As above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1831 little-endian system. */
1833 static inline bfd_boolean
1834 mips16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1836 switch (r_type)
1838 case R_MIPS16_26:
1839 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
1840 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
1841 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
1842 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
1843 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
1844 return TRUE;
1846 default:
1847 return FALSE;
1851 static inline bfd_boolean
1852 got16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1854 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_GOT16;
1857 static inline bfd_boolean
1858 call16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1860 return r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16;
1863 static inline bfd_boolean
1864 hi16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1866 return r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16;
1869 static inline bfd_boolean
1870 lo16_reloc_p (int r_type)
1872 return r_type == R_MIPS_LO16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16;
1875 static inline bfd_boolean
1876 mips16_call_reloc_p (int r_type)
1878 return r_type == R_MIPS16_26 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16;
1881 static inline bfd_boolean
1882 jal_reloc_p (int r_type)
1884 return r_type == R_MIPS_26 || r_type == R_MIPS16_26;
1887 void
1888 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1889 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1891 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1893 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type))
1894 return;
1896 /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction. */
1897 extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1898 insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1899 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1901 if (jal_shuffle)
1902 val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1903 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1904 else
1905 val = extend << 16 | insn;
1907 else
1908 val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1909 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1910 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1913 void
1914 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1915 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1917 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1919 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type))
1920 return;
1922 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1923 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1925 if (jal_shuffle)
1927 insn = val & 0xffff;
1928 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1929 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1931 else
1933 insn = val & 0xffff;
1934 extend = val >> 16;
1937 else
1939 insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1940 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1942 bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1943 bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1946 bfd_reloc_status_type
1947 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1948 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1949 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1951 bfd_vma relocation;
1952 bfd_signed_vma val;
1953 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1955 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1956 relocation = 0;
1957 else
1958 relocation = symbol->value;
1960 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1961 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1963 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1964 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1966 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
1967 val = reloc_entry->addend;
1969 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1971 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
1972 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1973 an external symbol. */
1974 if (! relocatable
1975 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1976 val += relocation - gp;
1978 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1980 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1981 (bfd_byte *) data
1982 + reloc_entry->address);
1983 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1984 return status;
1986 else
1987 reloc_entry->addend = val;
1989 if (relocatable)
1990 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1992 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1995 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1996 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1997 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1998 INPUT_SECTION. */
2000 struct mips_hi16
2002 struct mips_hi16 *next;
2003 bfd_byte *data;
2004 asection *input_section;
2005 arelent rel;
2008 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
2010 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
2012 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
2013 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
2014 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
2016 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
2017 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
2018 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
2019 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
2021 bfd_reloc_status_type
2022 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2023 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
2024 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2025 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2027 struct mips_hi16 *n;
2029 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2030 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2032 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
2033 if (n == NULL)
2034 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2036 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
2037 n->data = data;
2038 n->input_section = input_section;
2039 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
2040 mips_hi16_list = n;
2042 if (output_bfd != NULL)
2043 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2045 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2048 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations. This is just
2049 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
2050 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
2052 bfd_reloc_status_type
2053 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2054 void *data, asection *input_section,
2055 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2057 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
2058 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
2059 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
2060 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
2061 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2062 input_section, output_bfd,
2063 error_message);
2065 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2066 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
2069 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
2070 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
2071 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
2073 bfd_reloc_status_type
2074 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2075 void *data, asection *input_section,
2076 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2078 bfd_vma vallo;
2079 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2081 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2082 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2084 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2085 location);
2086 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
2087 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2088 location);
2090 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
2092 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
2093 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
2095 hi = mips_hi16_list;
2097 /* R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
2098 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS*_HI16
2099 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
2100 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
2101 has a rightshift of 0. */
2102 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
2103 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
2104 else if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS16_GOT16)
2105 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS16_HI16, FALSE);
2107 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
2108 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
2109 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
2111 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
2112 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
2113 error_message);
2114 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
2115 return ret;
2117 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
2118 free (hi);
2121 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2122 input_section, output_bfd,
2123 error_message);
2126 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
2127 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
2128 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
2130 bfd_reloc_status_type
2131 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2132 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2133 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2134 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2136 bfd_signed_vma val;
2137 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
2138 bfd_boolean relocatable;
2140 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
2142 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2143 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2145 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
2146 val = 0;
2147 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
2149 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
2150 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
2151 offset or address. */
2152 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
2153 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
2156 if (!relocatable)
2158 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
2159 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
2160 val += symbol->value;
2161 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
2163 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
2164 val -= input_section->output_offset;
2165 val -= reloc_entry->address;
2169 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
2170 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
2171 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
2172 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
2173 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
2174 reloc_entry->addend += val;
2175 else
2177 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2179 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
2180 val += reloc_entry->addend;
2182 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
2183 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2184 location);
2185 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
2186 location);
2187 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2188 location);
2190 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
2191 return status;
2194 if (relocatable)
2195 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2197 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2200 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
2201 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
2203 static void
2204 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
2205 Elf32_gptab *in)
2207 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2208 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2211 static void
2212 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
2213 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
2215 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2216 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2219 static void
2220 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
2221 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
2223 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
2224 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
2225 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
2226 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
2227 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
2228 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
2231 static void
2232 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
2233 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
2235 unsigned long l;
2237 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
2238 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
2239 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
2240 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
2241 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
2242 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
2243 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
2246 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
2247 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
2248 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
2250 void
2251 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
2252 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
2254 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2255 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2256 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2257 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2258 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2259 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2262 void
2263 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
2264 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
2266 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2267 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2268 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2269 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2270 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2271 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2274 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
2275 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
2276 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
2277 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
2278 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
2280 void
2281 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
2282 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
2284 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2285 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
2286 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2287 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2288 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2289 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2290 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2293 void
2294 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
2295 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
2297 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2298 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
2299 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2300 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2301 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2302 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2303 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2306 /* Swap in an options header. */
2308 void
2309 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
2310 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
2312 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
2313 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
2314 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
2315 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
2318 /* Swap out an options header. */
2320 void
2321 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
2322 Elf_External_Options *ex)
2324 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
2325 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
2326 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
2327 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
2330 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
2331 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
2333 static int
2334 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
2336 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
2337 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
2338 int diff;
2340 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
2341 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
2343 diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
2344 if (diff != 0)
2345 return diff;
2347 if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
2348 return -1;
2349 if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
2350 return 1;
2351 return 0;
2354 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
2356 static int
2357 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2358 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2360 #ifdef BFD64
2361 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
2362 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
2364 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2365 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
2366 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2367 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
2369 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2370 return -1;
2371 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2372 return 1;
2374 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2375 return -1;
2376 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2377 return 1;
2378 return 0;
2379 #else
2380 abort ();
2381 #endif
2385 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
2386 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
2387 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
2388 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
2389 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
2390 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
2391 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
2392 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
2393 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
2394 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
2395 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
2396 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
2397 when generating a final executable. */
2399 static bfd_boolean
2400 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2402 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
2403 bfd_boolean strip;
2404 asection *sec, *output_section;
2406 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2407 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2409 if (h->root.indx == -2)
2410 strip = FALSE;
2411 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
2412 || h->root.ref_dynamic
2413 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
2414 && !h->root.def_regular
2415 && !h->root.ref_regular)
2416 strip = TRUE;
2417 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
2418 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
2419 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
2420 h->root.root.root.string,
2421 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
2422 strip = TRUE;
2423 else
2424 strip = FALSE;
2426 if (strip)
2427 return TRUE;
2429 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
2431 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
2432 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
2433 h->esym.weakext = 0;
2434 h->esym.reserved = 0;
2435 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
2436 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2437 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
2439 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
2440 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
2442 const char *name;
2444 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
2445 special symbols. */
2446 name = h->root.root.root.string;
2447 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
2448 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
2450 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
2451 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2452 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2454 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
2456 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2457 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2458 h->esym.asym.value =
2459 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
2461 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
2463 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2464 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2465 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
2467 else
2468 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2470 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
2471 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2472 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2473 else
2475 const char *name;
2477 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
2478 output_section = sec->output_section;
2480 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
2481 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
2482 if (output_section == NULL)
2483 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2484 else
2486 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
2488 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
2489 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
2490 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
2491 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
2492 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
2493 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
2494 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
2495 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
2496 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
2497 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
2498 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
2499 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
2500 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
2501 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
2502 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
2503 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
2504 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
2505 else
2506 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2510 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
2511 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
2514 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
2515 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
2516 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2517 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2519 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
2520 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
2521 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
2522 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
2524 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
2525 output_section = sec->output_section;
2526 if (output_section != NULL)
2527 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
2528 + sec->output_offset
2529 + output_section->vma);
2530 else
2531 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2533 else
2535 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
2537 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2538 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
2540 if (hd->needs_lazy_stub)
2542 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
2543 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
2544 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
2545 if (sec == NULL)
2546 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2547 else
2549 output_section = sec->output_section;
2550 if (output_section != NULL)
2551 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
2552 + sec->output_offset
2553 + output_section->vma);
2554 else
2555 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2560 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
2561 h->root.root.root.string,
2562 &h->esym))
2564 einfo->failed = TRUE;
2565 return FALSE;
2568 return TRUE;
2571 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
2573 static int
2574 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
2576 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
2577 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
2579 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
2582 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
2584 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
2585 hash number. */
2587 static INLINE hashval_t
2588 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
2590 #ifdef BFD64
2591 return addr + (addr >> 32);
2592 #else
2593 return addr;
2594 #endif
2597 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
2598 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
2599 union members. */
2601 static hashval_t
2602 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2604 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2606 return entry->symndx
2607 + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
2608 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2609 : entry->abfd->id
2610 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
2611 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
2614 static int
2615 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2617 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2618 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2620 /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry. */
2621 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2622 return 0;
2624 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2625 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2626 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2627 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2630 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
2631 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
2632 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
2633 accordingly. */
2635 static hashval_t
2636 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2638 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2640 return entry->symndx
2641 + (! entry->abfd
2642 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2643 : entry->symndx >= 0
2644 ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2645 ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
2646 : (entry->abfd->id
2647 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
2648 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
2651 static int
2652 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2654 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2655 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2657 /* Any two LDM entries match. */
2658 if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2659 return 1;
2661 /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry. */
2662 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2663 return 0;
2665 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2666 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2667 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
2668 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2669 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2672 static hashval_t
2673 mips_got_page_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2675 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry;
2677 entry = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry_;
2678 return entry->abfd->id + entry->symndx;
2681 static int
2682 mips_got_page_entry_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
2684 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry1, *entry2;
2686 entry1 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry1_;
2687 entry2 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry2_;
2688 return entry1->abfd == entry2->abfd && entry1->symndx == entry2->symndx;
2691 /* Return the dynamic relocation section. If it doesn't exist, try to
2692 create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL. Also return NULL
2693 if creation fails. */
2695 static asection *
2696 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
2698 const char *dname;
2699 asection *sreloc;
2700 bfd *dynobj;
2702 dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
2703 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2704 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
2705 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
2707 sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
2708 (SEC_ALLOC
2709 | SEC_LOAD
2710 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2711 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2712 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2713 | SEC_READONLY));
2714 if (sreloc == NULL
2715 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
2716 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
2717 return NULL;
2719 return sreloc;
2722 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
2723 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
2724 is NULL). */
2726 static int
2727 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
2728 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2730 int indx = 0;
2731 int ret = 0;
2732 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2733 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2735 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
2736 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
2737 indx = h->dynindx;
2739 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2740 && (h == NULL
2741 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
2742 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2743 need_relocs = TRUE;
2745 if (!need_relocs)
2746 return FALSE;
2748 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2750 ret++;
2751 if (indx != 0)
2752 ret++;
2755 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2756 ret++;
2758 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
2759 ret++;
2761 return ret;
2764 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2765 ARG1, if it describes a local symbol. */
2767 static int
2768 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2770 struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2771 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2773 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2774 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2776 return 1;
2779 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2780 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2782 static int
2783 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2785 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2786 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2787 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2789 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2790 arg->needed += 2;
2791 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2792 arg->needed += 1;
2794 return 1;
2797 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2798 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2800 static int
2801 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2803 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2804 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2805 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2807 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2809 return 1;
2812 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
2814 static void
2815 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2816 asection *sreloc,
2817 unsigned long reloc_index,
2818 unsigned long indx,
2819 int r_type,
2820 bfd_vma offset)
2822 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2824 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2826 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2827 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2829 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2831 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2832 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2833 (sreloc->contents
2834 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2836 else
2837 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2838 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2839 (sreloc->contents
2840 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2843 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
2845 static void
2846 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2847 unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2848 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2849 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2850 bfd_vma value)
2852 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2853 int indx;
2854 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2855 bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2856 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2858 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2859 if (htab == NULL)
2860 return;
2862 sgot = htab->sgot;
2864 indx = 0;
2865 if (h != NULL)
2867 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2869 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2870 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2871 indx = h->root.dynindx;
2874 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2875 return;
2877 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2878 && (h == NULL
2879 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2880 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2881 need_relocs = TRUE;
2883 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
2884 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2885 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
2886 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2887 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2889 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
2890 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2892 /* General Dynamic. */
2893 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2895 offset = got_offset;
2896 offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2898 if (need_relocs)
2900 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2901 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
2902 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2903 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2905 if (indx)
2906 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2907 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
2908 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2909 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2910 else
2911 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2912 sgot->contents + offset2);
2914 else
2916 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2917 sgot->contents + offset);
2918 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2919 sgot->contents + offset2);
2922 got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2925 /* Initial Exec model. */
2926 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2928 offset = got_offset;
2930 if (need_relocs)
2932 if (indx == 0)
2933 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2934 sgot->contents + offset);
2935 else
2936 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2937 sgot->contents + offset);
2939 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2940 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
2941 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2942 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2944 else
2945 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2946 sgot->contents + offset);
2949 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2951 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2952 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
2953 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2954 sgot->contents + got_offset
2955 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2957 if (!info->shared)
2958 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2959 sgot->contents + got_offset);
2960 else
2961 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2962 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
2963 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2964 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2967 *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2970 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2971 a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models. The GOT entries for this
2972 symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX. This function initializes the
2973 GOT entries and corresponding relocations. */
2975 static bfd_vma
2976 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2977 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2978 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2980 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2981 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2983 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2985 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2987 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2988 if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2989 return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2990 else
2991 return got_index;
2994 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2996 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2997 return got_index;
3000 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
3002 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
3003 return got_index;
3006 return got_index;
3009 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
3010 for global symbol H. .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
3011 will be negative. */
3013 static bfd_vma
3014 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3015 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3017 bfd_vma plt_index, got_address, got_value;
3018 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3020 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3021 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3023 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1);
3025 /* This function only works for VxWorks, because a non-VxWorks .got.plt
3026 section starts with reserved entries. */
3027 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
3029 /* Calculate the index of the symbol's PLT entry. */
3030 plt_index = (h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size) / htab->plt_entry_size;
3032 /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry. */
3033 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
3034 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
3035 + plt_index * 4);
3037 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
3038 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
3039 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3040 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
3042 return got_address - got_value;
3045 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE. If there is not yet a GOT
3046 entry for this value, create one. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
3047 create a TLS GOT entry instead. Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
3048 offset can be found. */
3050 static bfd_vma
3051 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3052 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
3053 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
3055 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3056 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3058 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3059 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3061 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value,
3062 r_symndx, h, r_type);
3063 if (!entry)
3064 return MINUS_ONE;
3066 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3068 if (entry->symndx == -1 && htab->got_info->next == NULL)
3069 /* A type (3) entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
3070 hash table entry to track the index. */
3071 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, h->tls_got_offset, &h->tls_type,
3072 r_type, info, h, value);
3073 else
3074 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type,
3075 r_type, info, h, value);
3077 else
3078 return entry->gotidx;
3081 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
3083 static bfd_vma
3084 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3085 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3087 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3088 bfd_vma got_index;
3089 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
3090 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
3092 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3093 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3095 gg = g = htab->got_info;
3096 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
3098 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
3100 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
3102 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3103 if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3105 e.abfd = ibfd;
3106 e.symndx = -1;
3107 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
3108 e.tls_type = 0;
3110 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
3112 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
3114 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3116 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
3117 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3118 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3119 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
3120 value = (h->root.u.def.value
3121 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3122 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
3124 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
3125 info, e.d.h, value);
3127 else
3128 return p->gotidx;
3132 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
3133 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
3135 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3137 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
3138 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3139 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
3141 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3142 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3143 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
3144 value = (h->root.u.def.value
3145 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3146 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
3148 got_index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
3149 r_type, info, hm, value);
3151 else
3153 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
3154 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
3155 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
3156 offset. */
3157 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
3158 got_index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
3159 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
3161 BFD_ASSERT (got_index < htab->sgot->size);
3163 return got_index;
3166 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE. These
3167 entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
3168 within 32KB of GP. Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
3169 entry could be created. If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
3170 offset of the GOT entry from VALUE. */
3172 static bfd_vma
3173 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3174 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
3176 bfd_vma page, got_index;
3177 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3179 page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
3180 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, page, 0,
3181 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
3183 if (!entry)
3184 return MINUS_ONE;
3186 got_index = entry->gotidx;
3188 if (offsetp)
3189 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
3191 return got_index;
3194 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
3195 EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was originally against a global
3196 symbol that binds locally. */
3198 static bfd_vma
3199 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3200 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
3202 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3204 /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
3205 relocation; those against global symbols are not. Thus if the
3206 symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
3207 equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself. */
3208 if (! external)
3209 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
3211 /* It doesn't matter whether the original relocation was R_MIPS_GOT16,
3212 R_MIPS16_GOT16, R_MIPS_CALL16, etc. The format of the entry is the
3213 same in all cases. */
3214 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value, 0,
3215 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
3216 if (entry)
3217 return entry->gotidx;
3218 else
3219 return MINUS_ONE;
3222 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
3223 in the GOT. */
3225 static bfd_vma
3226 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *output_bfd,
3227 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma got_index)
3229 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3230 asection *sgot;
3231 bfd_vma gp;
3233 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3234 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3236 sgot = htab->sgot;
3237 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
3238 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
3240 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + got_index - gp;
3243 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
3244 from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON. Return NULL if it could not
3245 be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
3246 instead. */
3248 static struct mips_got_entry *
3249 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3250 bfd *ibfd, bfd_vma value,
3251 unsigned long r_symndx,
3252 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3253 int r_type)
3255 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
3256 struct mips_got_info *g;
3257 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3259 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3260 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3262 entry.abfd = NULL;
3263 entry.symndx = -1;
3264 entry.d.address = value;
3265 entry.tls_type = 0;
3267 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (htab->got_info, ibfd);
3268 if (g == NULL)
3270 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (htab->got_info, abfd);
3271 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3274 /* This function shouldn't be called for symbols that live in the global
3275 area of the GOT. */
3276 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
3277 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
3279 struct mips_got_entry *p;
3281 entry.abfd = ibfd;
3282 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
3284 entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
3285 entry.symndx = 0;
3286 entry.d.addend = 0;
3288 else if (h == NULL)
3290 entry.symndx = r_symndx;
3291 entry.d.addend = 0;
3293 else
3294 entry.d.h = h;
3296 p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
3297 htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
3299 BFD_ASSERT (p);
3300 return p;
3303 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
3304 INSERT);
3305 if (*loc)
3306 return *loc;
3308 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
3309 entry.tls_type = 0;
3311 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
3313 if (! *loc)
3314 return NULL;
3316 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
3318 if (g->assigned_gotno > g->local_gotno)
3320 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
3321 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
3322 (*_bfd_error_handler)
3323 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
3324 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3325 return NULL;
3328 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
3329 (htab->sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
3331 /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks. */
3332 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3334 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
3335 asection *s;
3336 bfd_byte *rloc;
3337 bfd_vma got_address;
3339 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3340 got_address = (htab->sgot->output_section->vma
3341 + htab->sgot->output_offset
3342 + entry.gotidx);
3344 rloc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
3345 outrel.r_offset = got_address;
3346 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
3347 outrel.r_addend = value;
3348 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, rloc);
3351 return *loc;
3354 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
3355 The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
3356 much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
3357 the current linking stage. */
3359 static bfd_size_type
3360 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3362 bfd_size_type count;
3364 count = 0;
3365 if (info->shared || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
3367 asection *p;
3368 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3370 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
3371 for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
3372 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3373 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3374 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
3375 ++count;
3377 return count;
3380 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
3381 appear towards the end. */
3383 static bfd_boolean
3384 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3386 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3387 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
3388 struct mips_got_info *g;
3390 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount == 0)
3391 return TRUE;
3393 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3394 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3396 g = htab->got_info;
3397 if (g == NULL)
3398 return TRUE;
3400 hsd.low = NULL;
3401 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
3402 = hsd.min_got_dynindx
3403 = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->reloc_only_gotno);
3404 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info) + 1;
3405 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
3406 elf_hash_table (info)),
3407 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
3408 &hsd);
3410 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
3411 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
3412 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
3413 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long) hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
3414 == elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
3415 BFD_ASSERT (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - hsd.min_got_dynindx
3416 == g->global_gotno);
3418 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
3419 table index in the GOT. */
3420 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
3422 return TRUE;
3425 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
3426 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
3427 index. */
3429 static bfd_boolean
3430 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
3432 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
3434 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3435 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3437 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
3438 at all. */
3439 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
3440 return TRUE;
3442 switch (h->global_got_area)
3444 case GGA_NONE:
3445 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
3446 break;
3448 case GGA_NORMAL:
3449 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
3451 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
3452 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3453 break;
3455 case GGA_RELOC_ONLY:
3456 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
3458 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
3459 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3460 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
3461 break;
3464 return TRUE;
3467 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
3468 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
3469 posterity. FOR_CALL is true if the caller is only interested in
3470 using the GOT entry for calls. */
3472 static bfd_boolean
3473 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3474 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3475 bfd_boolean for_call,
3476 unsigned char tls_flag)
3478 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3479 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
3480 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
3481 struct mips_got_info *g;
3483 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3484 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3486 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3487 if (!for_call)
3488 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
3490 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
3491 table. */
3492 if (h->dynindx == -1)
3494 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
3496 case STV_INTERNAL:
3497 case STV_HIDDEN:
3498 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
3499 break;
3501 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3502 return FALSE;
3505 /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into. */
3506 g = htab->got_info;
3507 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3509 entry.abfd = abfd;
3510 entry.symndx = -1;
3511 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3512 entry.tls_type = 0;
3514 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
3515 INSERT);
3517 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
3518 need to do it again. */
3519 if (*loc)
3521 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
3522 return TRUE;
3525 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
3527 if (! *loc)
3528 return FALSE;
3530 entry.gotidx = -1;
3531 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
3533 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
3535 if (tls_flag == 0)
3536 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_NORMAL;
3538 return TRUE;
3541 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
3542 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
3544 static bfd_boolean
3545 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
3546 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3547 unsigned char tls_flag)
3549 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3550 struct mips_got_info *g;
3551 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
3553 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3554 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3556 g = htab->got_info;
3557 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3559 entry.abfd = abfd;
3560 entry.symndx = symndx;
3561 entry.d.addend = addend;
3562 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
3563 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
3564 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
3566 if (*loc)
3568 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
3570 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3571 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
3573 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
3575 g->tls_gotno += 1;
3576 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
3578 return TRUE;
3581 if (tls_flag != 0)
3583 entry.gotidx = -1;
3584 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
3585 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
3586 g->tls_gotno += 1;
3587 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
3588 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3589 else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
3591 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
3592 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3595 else
3597 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
3598 entry.tls_type = 0;
3601 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
3603 if (! *loc)
3604 return FALSE;
3606 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
3608 return TRUE;
3611 /* Return the maximum number of GOT page entries required for RANGE. */
3613 static bfd_vma
3614 mips_elf_pages_for_range (const struct mips_got_page_range *range)
3616 return (range->max_addend - range->min_addend + 0x1ffff) >> 16;
3619 /* Record that ABFD has a page relocation against symbol SYMNDX and
3620 that ADDEND is the addend for that relocation.
3622 This function creates an upper bound on the number of GOT slots
3623 required; no attempt is made to combine references to non-overridable
3624 global symbols across multiple input files. */
3626 static bfd_boolean
3627 mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *abfd,
3628 long symndx, bfd_signed_vma addend)
3630 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3631 struct mips_got_info *g;
3632 struct mips_got_page_entry lookup, *entry;
3633 struct mips_got_page_range **range_ptr, *range;
3634 bfd_vma old_pages, new_pages;
3635 void **loc;
3637 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3638 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3640 g = htab->got_info;
3641 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3643 /* Find the mips_got_page_entry hash table entry for this symbol. */
3644 lookup.abfd = abfd;
3645 lookup.symndx = symndx;
3646 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, &lookup, INSERT);
3647 if (loc == NULL)
3648 return FALSE;
3650 /* Create a mips_got_page_entry if this is the first time we've
3651 seen the symbol. */
3652 entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *loc;
3653 if (!entry)
3655 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3656 if (!entry)
3657 return FALSE;
3659 entry->abfd = abfd;
3660 entry->symndx = symndx;
3661 entry->ranges = NULL;
3662 entry->num_pages = 0;
3663 *loc = entry;
3666 /* Skip over ranges whose maximum extent cannot share a page entry
3667 with ADDEND. */
3668 range_ptr = &entry->ranges;
3669 while (*range_ptr && addend > (*range_ptr)->max_addend + 0xffff)
3670 range_ptr = &(*range_ptr)->next;
3672 /* If we scanned to the end of the list, or found a range whose
3673 minimum extent cannot share a page entry with ADDEND, create
3674 a new singleton range. */
3675 range = *range_ptr;
3676 if (!range || addend < range->min_addend - 0xffff)
3678 range = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*range));
3679 if (!range)
3680 return FALSE;
3682 range->next = *range_ptr;
3683 range->min_addend = addend;
3684 range->max_addend = addend;
3686 *range_ptr = range;
3687 entry->num_pages++;
3688 g->page_gotno++;
3689 return TRUE;
3692 /* Remember how many pages the old range contributed. */
3693 old_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
3695 /* Update the ranges. */
3696 if (addend < range->min_addend)
3697 range->min_addend = addend;
3698 else if (addend > range->max_addend)
3700 if (range->next && addend >= range->next->min_addend - 0xffff)
3702 old_pages += mips_elf_pages_for_range (range->next);
3703 range->max_addend = range->next->max_addend;
3704 range->next = range->next->next;
3706 else
3707 range->max_addend = addend;
3710 /* Record any change in the total estimate. */
3711 new_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
3712 if (old_pages != new_pages)
3714 entry->num_pages += new_pages - old_pages;
3715 g->page_gotno += new_pages - old_pages;
3718 return TRUE;
3721 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD. */
3723 static void
3724 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3725 unsigned int n)
3727 asection *s;
3728 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3730 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3731 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3733 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3734 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3736 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3737 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
3738 else
3740 if (s->size == 0)
3742 /* Make room for a null element. */
3743 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
3744 ++s->reloc_count;
3746 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
3750 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries. Set boolean *DATA to true
3751 if the GOT entry is for an indirect or warning symbol. */
3753 static int
3754 mips_elf_check_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
3756 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3757 bfd_boolean *must_recreate;
3759 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
3760 must_recreate = (bfd_boolean *) data;
3761 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3763 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3765 h = entry->d.h;
3766 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3767 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3769 *must_recreate = TRUE;
3770 return 0;
3773 return 1;
3776 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries. Add all entries to
3777 hash table *DATA, converting entries for indirect and warning
3778 symbols into entries for the target symbol. Set *DATA to null
3779 on error. */
3781 static int
3782 mips_elf_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
3784 htab_t *new_got;
3785 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3786 void **slot;
3788 new_got = (htab_t *) data;
3789 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
3790 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3792 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3794 h = entry->d.h;
3795 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3796 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3798 BFD_ASSERT (h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
3799 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3801 entry->d.h = h;
3803 slot = htab_find_slot (*new_got, entry, INSERT);
3804 if (slot == NULL)
3806 *new_got = NULL;
3807 return 0;
3809 if (*slot == NULL)
3810 *slot = entry;
3811 else
3812 free (entry);
3813 return 1;
3816 /* If any entries in G->got_entries are for indirect or warning symbols,
3817 replace them with entries for the target symbol. */
3819 static bfd_boolean
3820 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3822 bfd_boolean must_recreate;
3823 htab_t new_got;
3825 must_recreate = FALSE;
3826 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_check_recreate_got, &must_recreate);
3827 if (must_recreate)
3829 new_got = htab_create (htab_size (g->got_entries),
3830 mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3831 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3832 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_recreate_got, &new_got);
3833 if (new_got == NULL)
3834 return FALSE;
3836 /* Each entry in g->got_entries has either been copied to new_got
3837 or freed. Now delete the hash table itself. */
3838 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3839 g->got_entries = new_got;
3841 return TRUE;
3844 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points
3845 to the link_info structure. Count the number of type (3) entries
3846 in the master GOT. */
3848 static int
3849 mips_elf_count_got_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
3851 struct bfd_link_info *info;
3852 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3853 struct mips_got_info *g;
3855 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
3856 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3857 g = htab->got_info;
3858 if (h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
3860 /* Make a final decision about whether the symbol belongs in the
3861 local or global GOT. Symbols that bind locally can (and in the
3862 case of forced-local symbols, must) live in the local GOT.
3863 Those that are aren't in the dynamic symbol table must also
3864 live in the local GOT.
3866 Note that the former condition does not always imply the
3867 latter: symbols do not bind locally if they are completely
3868 undefined. We'll report undefined symbols later if appropriate. */
3869 if (h->root.dynindx == -1
3870 || (h->got_only_for_calls
3871 ? SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root)
3872 : SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
3874 /* The symbol belongs in the local GOT. We no longer need this
3875 entry if it was only used for relocations; those relocations
3876 will be against the null or section symbol instead of H. */
3877 if (h->global_got_area != GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
3878 g->local_gotno++;
3879 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
3881 else if (htab->is_vxworks
3882 && h->got_only_for_calls
3883 && h->root.plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
3884 /* On VxWorks, calls can refer directly to the .got.plt entry;
3885 they don't need entries in the regular GOT. .got.plt entries
3886 will be allocated by _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
3887 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
3888 else
3890 g->global_gotno++;
3891 if (h->global_got_area == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
3892 g->reloc_only_gotno++;
3895 return 1;
3898 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
3900 static hashval_t
3901 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
3903 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
3904 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
3906 return entry->bfd->id;
3909 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
3911 static int
3912 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
3914 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
3915 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
3916 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
3917 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
3919 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
3922 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD. G must
3923 be the master GOT data. */
3925 static struct mips_got_info *
3926 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3928 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
3930 if (! g->bfd2got)
3931 return g;
3933 e.bfd = ibfd;
3934 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
3935 return p ? p->g : NULL;
3938 /* Use BFD2GOT to find ABFD's got entry, creating one if none exists.
3939 Return NULL if an error occured. */
3941 static struct mips_got_info *
3942 mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (struct htab *bfd2got, bfd *output_bfd,
3943 bfd *input_bfd)
3945 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
3946 struct mips_got_info *g;
3947 void **bfdgotp;
3949 bfdgot_entry.bfd = input_bfd;
3950 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
3951 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *) *bfdgotp;
3953 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3955 bfdgot = ((struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)
3956 bfd_alloc (output_bfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash)));
3957 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3958 return NULL;
3960 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3962 g = ((struct mips_got_info *)
3963 bfd_alloc (output_bfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info)));
3964 if (g == NULL)
3965 return NULL;
3967 bfdgot->bfd = input_bfd;
3968 bfdgot->g = g;
3970 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3971 g->global_gotno = 0;
3972 g->reloc_only_gotno = 0;
3973 g->local_gotno = 0;
3974 g->page_gotno = 0;
3975 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
3976 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3977 g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3978 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3979 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3980 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3981 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3982 return NULL;
3984 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
3985 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
3986 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
3987 return NULL;
3989 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3990 g->next = NULL;
3993 return bfdgot->g;
3996 /* A htab_traverse callback for the entries in the master got.
3997 Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
3998 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
3999 bfd requires. */
4001 static int
4002 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
4004 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
4005 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
4006 struct mips_got_info *g;
4008 g = mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (arg->bfd2got, arg->obfd, entry->abfd);
4009 if (g == NULL)
4011 arg->obfd = NULL;
4012 return 0;
4015 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
4016 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
4017 if (*entryp != NULL)
4018 return 1;
4020 *entryp = entry;
4022 if (entry->tls_type)
4024 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
4025 g->tls_gotno += 2;
4026 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
4027 g->tls_gotno += 1;
4029 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE)
4030 ++g->local_gotno;
4031 else
4032 ++g->global_gotno;
4034 return 1;
4037 /* A htab_traverse callback for the page entries in the master got.
4038 Associate each page entry with the bfd's got. */
4040 static int
4041 mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
4043 struct mips_got_page_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *entryp;
4044 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *) p;
4045 struct mips_got_info *g;
4047 g = mips_elf_get_got_for_bfd (arg->bfd2got, arg->obfd, entry->abfd);
4048 if (g == NULL)
4050 arg->obfd = NULL;
4051 return 0;
4054 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
4055 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, entry, INSERT);
4056 if (*entryp != NULL)
4057 return 1;
4059 *entryp = entry;
4060 g->page_gotno += entry->num_pages;
4061 return 1;
4064 /* Consider merging the got described by BFD2GOT with TO, using the
4065 information given by ARG. Return -1 if this would lead to overflow,
4066 1 if they were merged successfully, and 0 if a merge failed due to
4067 lack of memory. (These values are chosen so that nonnegative return
4068 values can be returned by a htab_traverse callback.) */
4070 static int
4071 mips_elf_merge_got_with (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got,
4072 struct mips_got_info *to,
4073 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg)
4075 struct mips_got_info *from = bfd2got->g;
4076 unsigned int estimate;
4078 /* Work out how many page entries we would need for the combined GOT. */
4079 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4080 if (estimate >= from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno)
4081 estimate = from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno;
4083 /* And conservatively estimate how many local and TLS entries
4084 would be needed. */
4085 estimate += from->local_gotno + to->local_gotno;
4086 estimate += from->tls_gotno + to->tls_gotno;
4088 /* If we're merging with the primary got, we will always have
4089 the full set of global entries. Otherwise estimate those
4090 conservatively as well. */
4091 if (to == arg->primary)
4092 estimate += arg->global_count;
4093 else
4094 estimate += from->global_gotno + to->global_gotno;
4096 /* Bail out if the combined GOT might be too big. */
4097 if (estimate > arg->max_count)
4098 return -1;
4100 /* Commit to the merge. Record that TO is now the bfd for this got. */
4101 bfd2got->g = to;
4103 /* Transfer the bfd's got information from FROM to TO. */
4104 htab_traverse (from->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, arg);
4105 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
4106 return 0;
4108 htab_traverse (from->got_page_entries, mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd, arg);
4109 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
4110 return 0;
4112 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
4113 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
4114 table anyway. */
4115 htab_delete (from->got_entries);
4116 htab_delete (from->got_page_entries);
4117 return 1;
4120 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
4121 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
4122 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
4123 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
4124 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
4125 and then make make the new got current. */
4127 static int
4128 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
4130 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
4131 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
4132 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
4133 struct mips_got_info *g;
4134 unsigned int estimate;
4135 int result;
4137 g = bfd2got->g;
4139 /* Work out the number of page, local and TLS entries. */
4140 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4141 if (estimate > g->page_gotno)
4142 estimate = g->page_gotno;
4143 estimate += g->local_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
4145 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
4146 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
4147 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
4148 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
4149 estimate += (g->tls_gotno > 0 ? arg->global_count : g->global_gotno);
4151 if (estimate <= arg->max_count)
4153 /* If we don't have a primary GOT, use it as
4154 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
4155 if (!arg->primary)
4157 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
4158 return 1;
4161 /* Try merging with the primary GOT. */
4162 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd2got, arg->primary, arg);
4163 if (result >= 0)
4164 return result;
4167 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
4168 if (arg->current)
4170 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd2got, arg->current, arg);
4171 if (result >= 0)
4172 return result;
4175 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
4176 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
4177 overflows anyway. */
4178 g->next = arg->current;
4179 arg->current = g;
4181 return 1;
4184 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. ENTRYP's NEXT field
4185 is null iff there is just a single GOT. */
4187 static int
4188 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
4190 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
4191 struct mips_got_info *g = p;
4192 bfd_vma next_index;
4193 unsigned char tls_type;
4195 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
4196 if (entry->tls_type == 0)
4197 return 1;
4199 next_index = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
4201 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
4203 /* A type (3) got entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
4204 hash table entry to track its index. */
4205 if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
4206 return 1;
4207 entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
4208 entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = next_index;
4209 tls_type = entry->d.h->tls_type;
4211 else
4213 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
4215 /* There are separate mips_got_entry objects for each input bfd
4216 that requires an LDM entry. Make sure that all LDM entries in
4217 a GOT resolve to the same index. */
4218 if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
4220 entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
4221 return 1;
4223 g->tls_ldm_offset = next_index;
4225 entry->gotidx = next_index;
4226 tls_type = entry->tls_type;
4229 /* Account for the entries we've just allocated. */
4230 if (tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
4231 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
4232 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
4233 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
4235 return 1;
4238 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
4239 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
4240 got) to the given VALUE.
4242 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
4243 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
4244 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
4245 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
4246 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
4247 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
4248 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
4249 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
4250 stub. */
4251 static int
4252 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
4254 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
4255 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
4256 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
4257 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
4259 if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
4260 arg->needed_relocs +=
4261 mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
4262 entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
4264 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4265 && entry->symndx == -1
4266 && entry->d.h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4268 if (g)
4270 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
4272 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
4273 if (arg->info->shared
4274 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
4275 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
4276 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
4277 ++arg->needed_relocs;
4279 else
4280 entry->d.h->global_got_area = arg->value;
4283 return 1;
4286 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries for which DATA is the
4287 bfd_link_info. Forbid any global symbols from having traditional
4288 lazy-binding stubs. */
4290 static int
4291 mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs (void **entryp, void *data)
4293 struct bfd_link_info *info;
4294 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4295 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4297 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4298 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
4299 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4300 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4302 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4303 && entry->symndx == -1
4304 && entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub)
4306 entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
4307 htab->lazy_stub_count--;
4310 return 1;
4313 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
4314 the primary GOT. */
4315 static bfd_vma
4316 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
4318 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
4319 return 0;
4321 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
4322 if (! g)
4323 return 0;
4325 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
4327 g = g->next;
4329 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
4330 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4333 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
4334 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
4336 static bfd_boolean
4337 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4338 asection *got, bfd_size_type pages)
4340 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4341 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
4342 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
4343 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
4344 unsigned int assign, needed_relocs;
4345 bfd *dynobj;
4347 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4348 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4349 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4351 g = htab->got_info;
4352 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
4353 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
4354 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
4355 return FALSE;
4357 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
4358 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
4359 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
4361 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
4362 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
4363 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
4364 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
4365 return FALSE;
4367 /* Also count how many page entries each input bfd requires. */
4368 htab_traverse (g->got_page_entries, mips_elf_make_got_pages_per_bfd,
4369 &got_per_bfd_arg);
4370 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
4371 return FALSE;
4373 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
4374 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
4375 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
4376 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
4377 - htab->reserved_gotno);
4378 got_per_bfd_arg.max_pages = pages;
4379 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
4380 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
4381 information. */
4382 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
4384 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
4385 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
4386 to be the primary GOT. */
4387 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
4388 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
4389 return FALSE;
4391 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
4392 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
4394 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
4395 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
4396 if (g->next == NULL)
4397 return FALSE;
4399 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
4400 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
4401 g->next->reloc_only_gotno = 0;
4402 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
4403 g->next->page_gotno = 0;
4404 g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
4405 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
4406 g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
4407 g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
4408 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
4409 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
4410 NULL);
4411 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
4412 return FALSE;
4413 g->next->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4414 mips_got_page_entry_eq,
4415 NULL);
4416 if (g->next->got_page_entries == NULL)
4417 return FALSE;
4418 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
4420 else
4421 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
4422 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
4424 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
4425 gg = g;
4426 g = g->next;
4428 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
4429 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
4430 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
4431 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
4432 list. */
4434 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
4435 void **bfdgotp;
4437 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
4438 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
4440 if (bfdgot == NULL)
4441 return FALSE;
4443 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
4444 bfdgot->g = g;
4445 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
4447 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
4448 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
4451 /* Every symbol that is referenced in a dynamic relocation must be
4452 present in the primary GOT, so arrange for them to appear after
4453 those that are actually referenced. */
4454 gg->reloc_only_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
4455 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
4457 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
4458 set_got_offset_arg.value = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
4459 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
4460 &set_got_offset_arg);
4461 set_got_offset_arg.value = GGA_NORMAL;
4462 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
4463 &set_got_offset_arg);
4465 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
4466 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
4467 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
4468 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
4469 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
4470 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
4471 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
4472 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
4473 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
4474 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
4475 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
4476 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
4477 points back to the master GOT. */
4478 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
4479 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
4480 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
4481 assign = 0;
4482 gg->next = gg;
4486 struct mips_got_info *gn;
4488 assign += htab->reserved_gotno;
4489 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
4490 g->local_gotno += assign;
4491 g->local_gotno += (pages < g->page_gotno ? pages : g->page_gotno);
4492 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
4494 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
4495 list that gg points to. g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
4496 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
4497 gn = g->next;
4498 g->next = gg->next;
4499 gg->next = g;
4501 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
4502 all non-TLS entries. */
4503 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
4504 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
4506 /* Move onto the next GOT. It will be a secondary GOT if nonull. */
4507 g = gn;
4509 /* Forbid global symbols in every non-primary GOT from having
4510 lazy-binding stubs. */
4511 if (g)
4512 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs, info);
4514 while (g);
4516 got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
4517 + gg->next->global_gotno
4518 + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4520 needed_relocs = 0;
4521 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4522 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
4523 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
4525 unsigned int save_assign;
4527 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
4528 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
4529 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
4530 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
4531 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
4532 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
4533 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
4534 &set_got_offset_arg);
4535 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
4536 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno <= g->global_gotno);
4538 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
4539 if (info->shared)
4541 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
4542 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
4543 + g->next->global_gotno
4544 + g->next->tls_gotno
4545 + htab->reserved_gotno);
4549 if (needed_relocs)
4550 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
4551 needed_relocs);
4553 return TRUE;
4557 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
4558 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
4560 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
4561 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
4562 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4563 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
4565 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
4567 while (relocation < relend)
4569 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
4570 && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
4571 return relocation;
4573 ++relocation;
4576 /* We didn't find it. */
4577 return NULL;
4580 /* Return whether an input relocation is against a local symbol. */
4582 static bfd_boolean
4583 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
4584 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4585 asection **local_sections)
4587 unsigned long r_symndx;
4588 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4589 size_t extsymoff;
4591 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4592 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
4593 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4595 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
4596 return TRUE;
4597 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
4598 return TRUE;
4600 return FALSE;
4603 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
4605 bfd_vma
4606 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
4608 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
4609 /* VALUE is negative. */
4610 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
4612 return value;
4615 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
4616 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
4617 BITS. */
4619 static bfd_boolean
4620 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
4622 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
4624 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
4625 /* The value is too big. */
4626 return TRUE;
4627 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
4628 /* The value is too small. */
4629 return TRUE;
4631 /* All is well. */
4632 return FALSE;
4635 /* Calculate the %high function. */
4637 static bfd_vma
4638 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
4640 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
4643 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
4645 static bfd_vma
4646 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4648 #ifdef BFD64
4649 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
4650 #else
4651 abort ();
4652 return MINUS_ONE;
4653 #endif
4656 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
4658 static bfd_vma
4659 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4661 #ifdef BFD64
4662 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
4663 #else
4664 abort ();
4665 return MINUS_ONE;
4666 #endif
4669 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
4671 static bfd_boolean
4672 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
4673 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4675 flagword flags;
4676 register asection *s;
4678 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
4680 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
4681 | SEC_READONLY);
4683 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
4684 if (s == NULL
4685 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
4686 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
4687 return FALSE;
4689 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
4692 return TRUE;
4695 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
4697 static bfd_boolean
4698 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4700 flagword flags;
4701 register asection *s;
4702 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4703 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
4704 struct mips_got_info *g;
4705 bfd_size_type amt;
4706 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4708 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4709 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4711 /* This function may be called more than once. */
4712 if (htab->sgot)
4713 return TRUE;
4715 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
4716 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4718 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
4719 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
4720 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
4721 if (s == NULL
4722 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
4723 return FALSE;
4724 htab->sgot = s;
4726 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
4727 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
4728 are not creating a global offset table. */
4729 bh = NULL;
4730 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
4731 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
4732 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
4733 return FALSE;
4735 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
4736 h->non_elf = 0;
4737 h->def_regular = 1;
4738 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
4739 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
4741 if (info->shared
4742 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
4743 return FALSE;
4745 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
4746 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4747 if (g == NULL)
4748 return FALSE;
4749 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
4750 g->global_gotno = 0;
4751 g->reloc_only_gotno = 0;
4752 g->tls_gotno = 0;
4753 g->local_gotno = 0;
4754 g->page_gotno = 0;
4755 g->assigned_gotno = 0;
4756 g->bfd2got = NULL;
4757 g->next = NULL;
4758 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
4759 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
4760 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
4761 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
4762 return FALSE;
4763 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4764 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
4765 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
4766 return FALSE;
4767 htab->got_info = g;
4768 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
4769 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
4771 /* We also need a .got.plt section when generating PLTs. */
4772 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
4773 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4774 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4775 if (s == NULL)
4776 return FALSE;
4777 htab->sgotplt = s;
4779 return TRUE;
4782 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
4783 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols. These symbols are only special for
4784 shared objects; they are not used in executables. */
4786 static bfd_boolean
4787 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4789 return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
4790 && info->shared
4791 && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
4792 || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
4795 /* Return TRUE if a relocation of type R_TYPE from INPUT_BFD might
4796 require an la25 stub. See also mips_elf_local_pic_function_p,
4797 which determines whether the destination function ever requires a
4798 stub. */
4800 static bfd_boolean
4801 mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (bfd *input_bfd, int r_type)
4803 /* We specifically ignore branches and jumps from EF_PIC objects,
4804 where the onus is on the compiler or programmer to perform any
4805 necessary initialization of $25. Sometimes such initialization
4806 is unnecessary; for example, -mno-shared functions do not use
4807 the incoming value of $25, and may therefore be called directly. */
4808 if (PIC_OBJECT_P (input_bfd))
4809 return FALSE;
4811 switch (r_type)
4813 case R_MIPS_26:
4814 case R_MIPS_PC16:
4815 case R_MIPS16_26:
4816 return TRUE;
4818 default:
4819 return FALSE;
4823 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
4824 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
4825 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
4827 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
4828 On exit, set *CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P to true if the relocation field
4829 is a MIPS16 jump to non-MIPS16 code, or vice versa.
4831 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
4832 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
4833 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
4834 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
4836 static bfd_reloc_status_type
4837 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
4838 asection *input_section,
4839 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4840 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4841 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
4842 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
4843 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
4844 const char **namep,
4845 bfd_boolean *cross_mode_jump_p,
4846 bfd_boolean save_addend)
4848 /* The eventual value we will return. */
4849 bfd_vma value;
4850 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
4851 occurring. */
4852 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
4853 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
4854 shared object file being produced. */
4855 bfd_vma gp;
4856 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
4857 relocated. */
4858 bfd_vma p;
4859 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
4860 bfd_vma gp0;
4861 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
4862 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
4863 during execution. */
4864 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
4865 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
4866 located. */
4867 asection *sec = NULL;
4868 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4869 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
4870 symbol. */
4871 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
4872 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
4873 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
4874 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
4875 "__gnu_local_gp". */
4876 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
4877 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4878 size_t extsymoff;
4879 unsigned long r_symndx;
4880 int r_type;
4881 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
4882 relocation value. */
4883 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
4884 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
4885 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
4886 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4887 bfd *dynobj;
4889 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4890 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4891 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4893 /* Parse the relocation. */
4894 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4895 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4896 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
4897 + input_section->output_offset
4898 + relocation->r_offset);
4900 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
4901 overflowed_p = FALSE;
4903 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
4904 used in the array of hash table entries. */
4905 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
4906 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4907 local_sections);
4908 was_local_p = local_p;
4909 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
4910 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
4911 else
4913 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
4914 must come before globals. */
4915 extsymoff = 0;
4918 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
4919 if (local_p)
4921 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4923 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
4924 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
4926 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4927 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
4928 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
4929 symbol += sym->st_value;
4930 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
4931 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
4933 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
4934 addend -= symbol;
4935 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4938 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
4939 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
4940 ++symbol;
4942 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
4943 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
4944 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
4945 sym->st_name);
4946 if (*namep == '\0')
4947 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
4949 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other);
4951 else
4953 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
4955 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
4956 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
4957 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
4958 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
4959 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4960 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4961 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
4963 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
4964 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
4966 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
4967 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
4968 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
4969 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
4971 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
4972 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
4973 if (!hi16_reloc_p (r_type) && !lo16_reloc_p (r_type))
4974 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4976 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
4978 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
4979 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
4980 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
4981 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
4984 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
4985 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
4986 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
4987 its defined. */
4988 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4989 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4990 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
4992 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4993 if (sec->output_section)
4994 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
4995 + sec->output_section->vma
4996 + sec->output_offset);
4997 else
4998 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
5000 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5001 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
5002 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
5003 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
5004 addresses. */
5005 symbol = 0;
5006 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
5007 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5008 symbol = 0;
5009 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
5010 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
5012 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
5013 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
5014 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
5015 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
5016 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
5017 somehow as well. */
5018 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
5019 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
5020 symbol = 0;
5022 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
5024 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
5025 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
5026 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
5027 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
5028 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
5029 which is available from here:
5030 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
5031 symbol = 0;
5033 else if ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
5034 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
5035 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
5036 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
5037 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other)))
5039 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
5041 else
5043 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5046 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other);
5049 /* If this is a reference to a 16-bit function with a stub, we need
5050 to redirect the relocation to the stub unless:
5052 (a) the relocation is for a MIPS16 JAL;
5054 (b) the relocation is for a MIPS16 PIC call, and there are no
5055 non-MIPS16 uses of the GOT slot; or
5057 (c) the section allows direct references to MIPS16 functions. */
5058 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26
5059 && !info->relocatable
5060 && ((h != NULL
5061 && h->fn_stub != NULL
5062 && (r_type != R_MIPS16_CALL16 || h->need_fn_stub))
5063 || (local_p
5064 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
5065 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5066 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (input_section))
5068 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
5069 have already noticed that we were going to need the
5070 stub. */
5071 if (local_p)
5072 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
5073 else
5075 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
5076 sec = h->fn_stub;
5079 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5080 /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't. */
5081 target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
5083 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
5084 need to redirect the call to the stub. Note that we specifically
5085 exclude R_MIPS16_CALL16 from this behavior; indirect calls should
5086 use an indirect stub instead. */
5087 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
5088 && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
5089 || (local_p
5090 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
5091 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5092 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5094 if (local_p)
5095 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
5096 else
5098 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
5099 out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
5100 file. */
5101 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
5103 asection *o;
5105 sec = NULL;
5106 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
5108 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
5110 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5111 break;
5114 if (sec == NULL)
5115 sec = h->call_stub;
5117 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
5118 sec = h->call_stub;
5119 else
5120 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5123 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
5124 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5126 /* If this is a direct call to a PIC function, redirect to the
5127 non-PIC stub. */
5128 else if (h != NULL && h->la25_stub
5129 && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (input_bfd, r_type))
5130 symbol = (h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_section->vma
5131 + h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_offset
5132 + h->la25_stub->offset);
5134 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
5135 mode change. */
5136 *cross_mode_jump_p = !info->relocatable
5137 && ((r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5138 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 || r_type == R_MIPS_JALR)
5139 && target_is_16_bit_code_p));
5141 local_p = h == NULL || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root);
5143 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
5144 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
5145 if (htab->got_info)
5146 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
5148 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
5149 symbol = gp;
5151 /* Global R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE relocations are equivalent to R_MIPS_GOT_DISP.
5152 The addend is applied by the corresponding R_MIPS_GOT_OFST. */
5153 if (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE && !local_p)
5155 r_type = R_MIPS_GOT_DISP;
5156 addend = 0;
5159 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, and we're going
5160 to need it, get it now. */
5161 switch (r_type)
5163 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
5164 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
5165 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5166 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5167 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5168 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5169 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5170 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5171 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5172 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
5173 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5174 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
5175 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
5176 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
5178 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5179 0, 0, NULL, r_type);
5180 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5181 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5183 else if (!local_p)
5185 /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
5186 entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub. */
5187 if (htab->is_vxworks
5188 && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16
5189 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
5190 || call16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5192 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5193 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
5194 g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
5196 else
5198 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5199 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, input_bfd,
5200 &h->root, r_type, info);
5201 if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
5202 && !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5203 /* This is a static link. We must initialize the GOT entry. */
5204 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, htab->sgot->contents + g);
5207 else if (!htab->is_vxworks
5208 && (call16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5209 /* The calculation below does not involve "g". */
5210 break;
5211 else
5213 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5214 symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
5215 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5216 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5219 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
5220 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, g);
5221 break;
5224 /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
5225 symbols are resolved by the loader. Add them to .rela.dyn. */
5226 if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
5228 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
5229 bfd_byte *loc;
5230 asection *s;
5232 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
5233 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5235 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
5236 + input_section->output_offset
5237 + relocation->r_offset);
5238 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
5239 outrel.r_addend = addend;
5240 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
5242 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
5243 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
5244 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
5245 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
5246 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5248 *valuep = 0;
5249 return bfd_reloc_ok;
5252 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
5253 switch (r_type)
5255 case R_MIPS_NONE:
5256 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5258 case R_MIPS_16:
5259 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
5260 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5261 break;
5263 case R_MIPS_32:
5264 case R_MIPS_REL32:
5265 case R_MIPS_64:
5266 if ((info->shared
5267 || (htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
5268 && h != NULL
5269 && h->root.def_dynamic
5270 && !h->root.def_regular
5271 && !h->has_static_relocs))
5272 && r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
5273 && (h == NULL
5274 || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5275 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5276 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
5278 /* If we're creating a shared library, then we can't know
5279 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
5280 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
5281 linker. We must do the same for executable references to
5282 shared library symbols, unless we've decided to use copy
5283 relocs or PLTs instead. */
5284 value = addend;
5285 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
5286 info,
5287 relocation,
5289 sec,
5290 symbol,
5291 &value,
5292 input_section))
5293 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
5295 else
5297 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
5298 value = symbol + addend;
5299 else
5300 value = addend;
5302 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5303 break;
5305 case R_MIPS_PC32:
5306 value = symbol + addend - p;
5307 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5308 break;
5310 case R_MIPS16_26:
5311 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
5312 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
5313 the output file that's different. That's handled in
5314 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
5315 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
5316 case R_MIPS_26:
5317 if (was_local_p)
5318 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
5319 else
5321 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
5322 if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5323 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
5325 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5326 break;
5328 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
5329 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
5330 & howto->dst_mask);
5331 break;
5333 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
5334 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
5335 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
5336 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
5337 break;
5339 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
5340 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
5341 & howto->dst_mask);
5342 break;
5344 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
5345 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
5346 break;
5348 case R_MIPS_HI16:
5349 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
5350 if (!gp_disp_p)
5352 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
5353 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5355 else
5357 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
5358 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
5359 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
5360 8: sll $v0,16
5361 12: addu $v0,$v1
5362 14: move $gp,$v0
5363 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
5364 $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
5365 both reloc addends by 4. */
5366 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
5367 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
5368 else
5369 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
5370 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5372 break;
5374 case R_MIPS_LO16:
5375 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
5376 if (!gp_disp_p)
5377 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
5378 else
5380 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
5381 for this conditional. */
5382 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
5383 value = addend + gp - p;
5384 else
5385 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
5386 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
5387 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
5388 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
5389 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
5390 this:
5392 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
5393 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
5394 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
5396 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
5397 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
5398 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
5399 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
5400 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
5401 not check for overflow here. */
5403 break;
5405 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
5406 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
5407 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
5408 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
5409 here. */
5411 /* Fall through. */
5413 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
5414 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
5415 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
5416 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
5417 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
5418 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
5419 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
5420 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
5421 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
5422 if (howto->partial_inplace)
5423 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
5424 value = symbol + addend - gp;
5425 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
5426 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
5427 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
5428 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
5429 to them before. */
5430 if (was_local_p)
5431 value += gp0;
5432 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5433 break;
5435 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
5436 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
5437 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5438 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5439 /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
5440 R_MIPS*_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G". */
5441 if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
5443 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5444 symbol + addend, !was_local_p);
5445 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
5446 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5447 value
5448 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
5449 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5450 break;
5453 /* Fall through. */
5455 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
5456 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5457 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
5458 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5459 value = g;
5460 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5461 break;
5463 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
5464 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
5465 if (!save_addend)
5466 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5467 break;
5469 case R_MIPS_PC16:
5470 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
5471 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
5472 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
5473 value >>= howto->rightshift;
5474 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5475 break;
5477 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5478 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5479 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
5480 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
5481 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
5482 value = g;
5483 value = mips_elf_high (value);
5484 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5485 break;
5487 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5488 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5489 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
5490 break;
5492 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5493 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
5494 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
5495 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5496 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
5497 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5498 break;
5500 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
5501 if (local_p)
5502 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
5503 else
5504 value = addend;
5505 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
5506 break;
5508 case R_MIPS_SUB:
5509 value = symbol - addend;
5510 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5511 break;
5513 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
5514 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
5515 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5516 break;
5518 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
5519 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
5520 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5521 break;
5523 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
5524 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
5525 value &= howto->dst_mask;
5526 break;
5528 case R_MIPS_JALR:
5529 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
5530 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
5531 when the symbol does not resolve locally. */
5532 if (h != NULL && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
5533 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5534 value = symbol + addend;
5535 break;
5537 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
5538 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
5539 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
5540 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
5541 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5543 default:
5544 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
5545 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5548 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
5549 *valuep = value;
5550 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
5553 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
5555 static bfd_vma
5556 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
5557 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5558 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
5560 bfd_vma x;
5561 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
5563 /* Obtain the bytes. */
5564 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
5566 return x;
5569 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
5570 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
5571 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
5572 relocation applies.
5573 CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P is true if the relocation field
5574 is a MIPS16 jump to non-MIPS16 code, or vice versa.
5576 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
5578 static bfd_boolean
5579 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5580 reloc_howto_type *howto,
5581 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5582 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
5583 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
5584 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p)
5586 bfd_vma x;
5587 bfd_byte *location;
5588 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5590 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
5591 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
5593 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
5595 /* Obtain the current value. */
5596 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
5598 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
5599 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
5601 /* Set the field. */
5602 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
5604 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
5605 if (cross_mode_jump_p && jal_reloc_p (r_type))
5607 bfd_boolean ok;
5608 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
5609 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
5611 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
5612 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
5614 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
5615 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
5617 else
5619 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
5620 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
5623 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
5624 if (!ok)
5626 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5627 (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: Direct jumps between ISA modes are not allowed; consider recompiling with interlinking enabled."),
5628 input_bfd,
5629 input_section,
5630 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
5631 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5632 return FALSE;
5635 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
5636 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
5639 /* Try converting JAL to BAL and J(AL)R to B(AL), if the target is in
5640 range. */
5641 if (!info->relocatable
5642 && !cross_mode_jump_p
5643 && ((JAL_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
5644 && r_type == R_MIPS_26
5645 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
5646 || (JALR_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
5647 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
5648 && x == 0x0320f809) /* jalr t9 */
5649 || (JR_TO_B_P (input_bfd)
5650 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
5651 && x == 0x03200008))) /* jr t9 */
5653 bfd_vma addr;
5654 bfd_vma dest;
5655 bfd_signed_vma off;
5657 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
5658 + input_section->output_offset
5659 + relocation->r_offset
5660 + 4);
5661 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
5662 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
5663 else
5664 dest = value;
5665 off = dest - addr;
5666 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
5668 if (x == 0x03200008) /* jr t9 */
5669 x = 0x10000000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* b addr */
5670 else
5671 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
5675 /* Put the value into the output. */
5676 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
5678 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
5679 location);
5681 return TRUE;
5684 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
5685 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
5686 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
5687 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
5689 static bfd_boolean
5690 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
5691 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5692 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
5693 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
5694 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
5695 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
5697 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
5698 asection *sreloc;
5699 bfd *dynobj;
5700 int r_type;
5701 long indx;
5702 bfd_boolean defined_p;
5703 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5705 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5706 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
5708 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
5709 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5710 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
5711 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
5712 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
5713 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
5714 < sreloc->size);
5716 outrel[0].r_offset =
5717 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
5718 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
5720 outrel[1].r_offset =
5721 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
5722 outrel[2].r_offset =
5723 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
5726 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
5727 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
5728 return TRUE;
5730 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
5732 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
5733 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
5734 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
5735 *addendp += symbol;
5736 return TRUE;
5739 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
5740 in the relocation. */
5741 if (h != NULL && ! SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
5743 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks || h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE);
5744 indx = h->root.dynindx;
5745 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
5746 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
5747 else
5748 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
5749 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
5750 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
5751 undefined symbols. */
5752 defined_p = FALSE;
5754 else
5756 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
5757 indx = 0;
5758 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
5760 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5761 return FALSE;
5763 else
5765 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
5766 if (indx == 0)
5768 asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
5769 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
5771 if (indx == 0)
5772 abort ();
5775 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
5776 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
5777 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
5778 local symbols because we used to generate them
5779 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
5780 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
5781 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
5782 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
5783 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
5784 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
5785 as well. */
5786 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
5787 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
5788 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
5789 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
5790 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
5791 indx = 0;
5792 defined_p = TRUE;
5795 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
5796 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
5797 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
5798 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
5799 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
5800 *addendp += symbol;
5802 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5803 /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this. */
5804 outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
5805 else
5806 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
5807 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
5808 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
5809 R_MIPS_REL32);
5811 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
5812 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
5813 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
5814 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
5815 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
5816 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
5817 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
5818 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
5819 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
5820 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
5821 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
5822 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
5823 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
5824 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
5825 ? R_MIPS_64
5826 : R_MIPS_NONE);
5827 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
5829 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
5830 correct location in the output file. */
5831 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
5832 + input_section->output_offset);
5833 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
5834 + input_section->output_offset);
5835 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
5836 + input_section->output_offset);
5838 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
5839 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
5840 relocation format is non-standard. */
5841 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
5843 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
5844 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
5845 (sreloc->contents
5846 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
5848 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
5850 /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations. */
5851 outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
5852 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
5853 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
5854 (sreloc->contents
5855 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
5857 else
5858 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
5859 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
5860 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
5862 /* We've now added another relocation. */
5863 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
5865 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
5866 will be writing to it. */
5867 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
5868 |= SHF_WRITE;
5870 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
5871 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
5873 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
5874 bfd_byte *cr;
5876 if (scpt)
5878 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
5880 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
5881 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
5882 + input_section->output_section->vma
5883 + input_section->output_offset);
5884 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
5885 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
5886 else
5887 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
5888 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
5889 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
5891 cr = (scpt->contents
5892 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
5893 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
5894 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
5895 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
5896 + scpt->reloc_count));
5897 ++scpt->reloc_count;
5901 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
5902 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
5903 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
5904 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
5905 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5907 return TRUE;
5910 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
5912 unsigned long
5913 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
5915 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
5917 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
5918 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
5920 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
5921 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
5923 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
5924 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
5926 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
5927 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
5929 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
5930 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
5932 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
5933 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
5935 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
5936 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
5938 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
5939 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
5941 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
5942 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
5944 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
5945 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
5947 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E:
5948 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e;
5950 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F:
5951 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f;
5953 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A:
5954 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a;
5956 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
5957 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
5959 case E_MIPS_MACH_XLR:
5960 return bfd_mach_mips_xlr;
5962 default:
5963 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
5965 default:
5966 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
5967 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
5969 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
5970 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
5972 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
5973 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
5975 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
5976 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
5978 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
5979 return bfd_mach_mips5;
5981 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
5982 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
5984 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
5985 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
5987 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
5988 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
5990 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
5991 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
5995 return 0;
5998 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
6000 static INLINE char *
6001 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
6003 flagword flags;
6005 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
6006 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
6008 case 0:
6009 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
6010 return "N32";
6011 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
6012 return "64";
6013 else
6014 return "none";
6015 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
6016 return "O32";
6017 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
6018 return "O64";
6019 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
6020 return "EABI32";
6021 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
6022 return "EABI64";
6023 default:
6024 return "unknown abi";
6028 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
6029 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
6030 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
6031 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
6032 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
6033 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
6034 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6035 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
6037 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
6038 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
6039 definition in a shared library. */
6040 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
6041 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6042 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
6044 /* This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
6046 void
6047 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
6049 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
6051 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use. */
6052 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
6053 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
6055 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
6056 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
6057 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
6058 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
6059 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
6060 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
6061 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
6063 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
6064 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
6065 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
6066 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6067 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6068 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
6069 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
6070 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
6071 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6072 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
6074 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
6075 break;
6077 case SHN_COMMON:
6078 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
6079 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
6080 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
6081 || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
6082 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
6083 break;
6084 /* Fall through. */
6085 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
6086 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
6088 /* Initialize the small common section. */
6089 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
6090 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
6091 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6092 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6093 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
6094 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
6095 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
6096 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6097 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
6099 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
6100 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
6101 break;
6103 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
6104 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6105 break;
6107 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
6109 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
6111 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
6112 if (section != NULL)
6114 asym->section = section;
6115 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
6116 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
6117 base address to make it an offset. */
6118 asym->value -= section->vma;
6121 break;
6123 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
6125 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
6127 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
6128 if (section != NULL)
6130 asym->section = section;
6131 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
6132 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
6133 base address to make it an offset. */
6134 asym->value -= section->vma;
6137 break;
6140 /* If this is an odd-valued function symbol, assume it's a MIPS16 one. */
6141 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_FUNC
6142 && (asym->value & 1) != 0)
6144 asym->value--;
6145 elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other
6146 = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS16 (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
6150 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
6151 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
6153 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
6154 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
6155 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
6156 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
6157 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
6159 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
6160 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
6161 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
6162 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
6164 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
6165 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
6166 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
6167 We therefore take the following approach:
6169 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
6170 determine the pointer size.
6172 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
6173 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
6175 - Otherwise punt.
6177 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
6178 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
6179 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
6180 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
6181 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
6183 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
6184 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
6185 did so. */
6187 unsigned int
6188 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
6190 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
6191 return 8;
6192 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
6194 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
6196 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
6197 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
6198 if (long32_p && long64_p)
6199 return 0;
6200 if (long32_p)
6201 return 4;
6202 if (long64_p)
6203 return 8;
6205 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
6206 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
6207 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
6208 == R_MIPS_64))
6209 return 8;
6211 return 0;
6213 return 4;
6216 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
6217 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
6218 same address. For example, if we have code like:
6220 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
6221 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
6222 jalr $25
6224 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
6225 will jump there rather than to .text.
6227 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
6228 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
6230 bfd_boolean
6231 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
6233 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
6236 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
6237 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
6238 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
6239 a better way. */
6241 bfd_boolean
6242 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
6244 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
6245 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
6247 bfd_byte buf[4];
6249 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
6250 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
6252 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
6253 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
6254 SEEK_SET) != 0)
6255 return FALSE;
6256 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
6257 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
6258 return FALSE;
6261 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
6262 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6263 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
6264 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
6266 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
6268 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
6269 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
6270 so that we don't have to read them again.
6271 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
6272 through the section contents to see if there is an
6273 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
6275 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
6276 l = contents;
6277 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
6278 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
6280 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
6282 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
6283 &intopt);
6284 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
6286 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6287 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
6288 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
6289 break;
6291 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6293 bfd_byte buf[8];
6295 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
6296 (hdr->sh_offset
6297 + (l - contents)
6298 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
6299 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
6300 SEEK_SET) != 0)
6301 return FALSE;
6302 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
6303 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
6304 return FALSE;
6306 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6308 bfd_byte buf[4];
6310 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
6311 (hdr->sh_offset
6312 + (l - contents)
6313 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
6314 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
6315 SEEK_SET) != 0)
6316 return FALSE;
6317 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
6318 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
6319 return FALSE;
6321 l += intopt.size;
6325 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
6327 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
6329 /* .sbss is not handled specially here because the GNU/Linux
6330 prelinker can convert .sbss from NOBITS to PROGBITS and
6331 changing it back to NOBITS breaks the binary. The entry in
6332 _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections will ensure the correct flags
6333 are set on .sbss if BFD creates it without reading it from an
6334 input file, and without special handling here the flags set
6335 on it in an input file will be followed. */
6336 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
6337 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
6338 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
6340 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
6341 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
6343 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
6345 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
6346 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
6348 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
6350 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
6351 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
6353 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
6355 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
6357 unsigned int adjust;
6359 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
6360 if (adjust != 0)
6361 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
6366 return TRUE;
6369 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
6370 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
6371 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
6373 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
6374 how to. */
6376 bfd_boolean
6377 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
6378 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
6379 const char *name,
6380 int shindex)
6382 flagword flags = 0;
6384 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
6385 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
6386 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
6387 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
6388 probably get away with this. */
6389 switch (hdr->sh_type)
6391 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
6392 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
6393 return FALSE;
6394 break;
6395 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
6396 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
6397 return FALSE;
6398 break;
6399 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
6400 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
6401 return FALSE;
6402 break;
6403 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
6404 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
6405 return FALSE;
6406 break;
6407 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
6408 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
6409 return FALSE;
6410 break;
6411 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
6412 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
6413 return FALSE;
6414 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
6415 break;
6416 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
6417 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
6418 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
6419 return FALSE;
6420 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
6421 break;
6422 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
6423 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
6424 return FALSE;
6425 break;
6426 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
6427 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
6428 return FALSE;
6429 break;
6430 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
6431 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
6432 return FALSE;
6433 break;
6434 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
6435 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
6436 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
6437 return FALSE;
6438 break;
6439 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
6440 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
6441 return FALSE;
6442 break;
6443 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
6444 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
6445 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
6446 return FALSE;
6447 break;
6448 default:
6449 break;
6452 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
6453 return FALSE;
6455 if (flags)
6457 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
6458 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
6459 hdr->bfd_section)
6460 | flags)))
6461 return FALSE;
6464 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
6466 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
6467 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
6468 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
6469 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
6470 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
6472 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
6473 Elf32_RegInfo s;
6475 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
6476 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
6477 return FALSE;
6478 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
6479 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
6482 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
6483 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
6484 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
6485 they should agree. */
6486 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
6488 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
6490 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
6491 if (contents == NULL)
6492 return FALSE;
6493 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
6494 0, hdr->sh_size))
6496 free (contents);
6497 return FALSE;
6499 l = contents;
6500 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
6501 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
6503 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
6505 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
6506 &intopt);
6507 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
6509 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6510 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
6511 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
6512 break;
6514 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6516 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
6518 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
6519 (abfd,
6520 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
6521 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
6522 &intreg);
6523 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
6525 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
6527 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
6529 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
6530 (abfd,
6531 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
6532 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
6533 &intreg);
6534 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
6536 l += intopt.size;
6538 free (contents);
6541 return TRUE;
6544 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
6545 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
6546 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
6548 bfd_boolean
6549 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
6551 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
6553 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
6555 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
6556 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
6557 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
6559 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
6560 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
6561 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
6563 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
6564 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
6565 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
6567 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
6568 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
6569 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
6571 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
6572 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
6573 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
6574 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6575 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6576 else
6577 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
6579 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
6581 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
6582 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
6583 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
6584 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6586 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6587 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
6588 else
6589 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
6591 else
6592 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
6594 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
6595 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
6596 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
6597 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
6599 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6600 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
6601 #if 0
6602 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
6603 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
6604 #endif
6606 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
6607 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
6608 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
6609 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
6610 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
6611 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
6612 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
6613 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
6615 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
6616 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6618 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
6620 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
6621 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6622 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
6624 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
6626 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
6627 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
6628 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6630 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
6631 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
6633 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
6635 /* Irix facilities such as libexc expect a single .debug_frame
6636 per executable, the system ones have NOSTRIP set and the linker
6637 doesn't merge sections with different flags so ... */
6638 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_frame"))
6639 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6641 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
6643 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
6644 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
6645 final_write_processing. */
6647 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
6648 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
6650 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
6651 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
6652 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
6654 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
6656 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
6657 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
6658 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
6661 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
6662 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
6663 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
6664 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
6665 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
6667 return TRUE;
6670 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
6671 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
6672 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
6673 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
6674 the .scommon section. */
6676 bfd_boolean
6677 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6678 asection *sec, int *retval)
6680 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
6682 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
6683 return TRUE;
6685 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
6687 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
6688 return TRUE;
6690 return FALSE;
6693 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
6694 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
6696 bfd_boolean
6697 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6698 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
6699 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6700 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
6702 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
6703 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
6704 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
6706 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
6707 *namep = NULL;
6708 return TRUE;
6711 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
6712 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
6713 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
6714 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
6715 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
6716 is not done for them. */
6717 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
6718 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6719 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
6721 *namep = NULL;
6722 return TRUE;
6725 switch (sym->st_shndx)
6727 case SHN_COMMON:
6728 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
6729 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
6730 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
6731 || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
6732 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
6733 break;
6734 /* Fall through. */
6735 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
6736 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
6737 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
6738 *valp = sym->st_size;
6739 break;
6741 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
6742 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
6743 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
6745 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
6746 asection *elf_text_section;
6747 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
6749 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6750 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
6751 return FALSE;
6753 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
6754 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6755 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
6756 return FALSE;
6758 /* Initialize the section. */
6760 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
6761 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
6763 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
6764 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
6766 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
6767 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
6768 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
6769 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
6770 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
6771 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
6772 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
6774 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
6775 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
6776 so I took it out. */
6777 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
6778 break;
6780 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
6781 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
6782 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
6783 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
6784 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
6786 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
6787 asection *elf_data_section;
6788 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
6790 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6791 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
6792 return FALSE;
6794 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
6795 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6796 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
6797 return FALSE;
6799 /* Initialize the section. */
6801 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
6802 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
6804 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
6805 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
6807 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
6808 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
6809 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
6810 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
6811 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
6812 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
6813 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
6815 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
6816 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
6817 so I took it out. */
6818 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
6819 break;
6821 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
6822 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6823 break;
6826 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
6827 && ! info->shared
6828 && info->output_bfd->xvec == abfd->xvec
6829 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
6831 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6832 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
6834 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
6835 bh = NULL;
6836 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6837 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
6838 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6839 return FALSE;
6841 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6842 h->non_elf = 0;
6843 h->def_regular = 1;
6844 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
6846 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6847 return FALSE;
6849 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
6852 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
6853 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
6854 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
6855 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
6856 ++*valp;
6858 return TRUE;
6861 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
6862 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
6863 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
6866 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
6867 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6868 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
6869 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6871 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
6872 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
6873 common in the output file. */
6874 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
6875 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
6876 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
6878 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
6879 sym->st_value &= ~1;
6881 return 1;
6884 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
6886 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
6888 bfd_boolean
6889 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
6891 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6892 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
6893 flagword flags;
6894 register asection *s;
6895 const char * const *namep;
6896 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6898 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6899 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
6901 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
6902 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
6904 /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
6905 EABI doesn't. */
6906 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
6908 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6909 if (s != NULL)
6911 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
6912 return FALSE;
6916 /* We need to create .got section. */
6917 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
6918 return FALSE;
6920 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
6921 return FALSE;
6923 /* Create .stub section. */
6924 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
6925 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
6926 flags | SEC_CODE);
6927 if (s == NULL
6928 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
6929 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
6930 return FALSE;
6931 htab->sstubs = s;
6933 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
6934 && !info->shared
6935 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
6937 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
6938 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
6939 if (s == NULL
6940 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
6941 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
6942 return FALSE;
6945 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
6946 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
6947 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
6948 the linker takes such action. */
6949 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
6951 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
6953 bh = NULL;
6954 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6955 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
6956 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6957 return FALSE;
6959 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6960 h->non_elf = 0;
6961 h->def_regular = 1;
6962 h->type = STT_SECTION;
6964 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6965 return FALSE;
6968 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
6969 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6971 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
6972 return FALSE;
6975 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
6976 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
6977 if (s != NULL)
6978 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6979 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
6980 if (s != NULL)
6981 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6982 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
6983 if (s != NULL)
6984 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6985 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
6986 if (s != NULL)
6987 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6988 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6989 if (s != NULL)
6990 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6993 if (!info->shared)
6995 const char *name;
6997 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
6998 bh = NULL;
6999 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7000 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
7001 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7002 return FALSE;
7004 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7005 h->non_elf = 0;
7006 h->def_regular = 1;
7007 h->type = STT_SECTION;
7009 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7010 return FALSE;
7012 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
7014 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
7015 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
7016 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
7017 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
7018 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
7019 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7021 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
7022 bh = NULL;
7023 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7024 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
7025 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7026 return FALSE;
7028 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7029 h->non_elf = 0;
7030 h->def_regular = 1;
7031 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
7033 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7034 return FALSE;
7038 /* Create the .plt, .rel(a).plt, .dynbss and .rel(a).bss sections.
7039 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE symbol. */
7040 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
7041 return FALSE;
7043 /* Cache the sections created above. */
7044 htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
7045 htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynbss");
7046 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7048 htab->srelbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.bss");
7049 htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
7051 else
7052 htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rel.plt");
7053 if (!htab->sdynbss
7054 || (htab->is_vxworks && !htab->srelbss && !info->shared)
7055 || !htab->srelplt
7056 || !htab->splt)
7057 abort ();
7059 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7061 /* Do the usual VxWorks handling. */
7062 if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
7063 return FALSE;
7065 /* Work out the PLT sizes. */
7066 if (info->shared)
7068 htab->plt_header_size
7069 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
7070 htab->plt_entry_size
7071 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
7073 else
7075 htab->plt_header_size
7076 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
7077 htab->plt_entry_size
7078 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
7081 else if (!info->shared)
7083 /* All variants of the plt0 entry are the same size. */
7084 htab->plt_header_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
7085 htab->plt_entry_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
7088 return TRUE;
7091 /* Return true if relocation REL against section SEC is a REL rather than
7092 RELA relocation. RELOCS is the first relocation in the section and
7093 ABFD is the bfd that contains SEC. */
7095 static bfd_boolean
7096 mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
7097 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7098 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
7100 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7101 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7103 /* To determine which flavor of relocation this is, we depend on the
7104 fact that the INPUT_SECTION's REL_HDR is read before RELA_HDR. */
7105 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
7106 if (rel_hdr == NULL)
7107 return FALSE;
7108 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7109 return ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7110 < NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
7113 /* Read the addend for REL relocation REL, which belongs to bfd ABFD.
7114 HOWTO is the relocation's howto and CONTENTS points to the contents
7115 of the section that REL is against. */
7117 static bfd_vma
7118 mips_elf_read_rel_addend (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7119 reloc_howto_type *howto, bfd_byte *contents)
7121 bfd_byte *location;
7122 unsigned int r_type;
7123 bfd_vma addend;
7125 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7126 location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7128 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
7129 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
7130 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, abfd, contents);
7131 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
7133 return addend & howto->src_mask;
7136 /* REL is a relocation in ABFD that needs a partnering LO16 relocation
7137 and *ADDEND is the addend for REL itself. Look for the LO16 relocation
7138 and update *ADDEND with the final addend. Return true on success
7139 or false if the LO16 could not be found. RELEND is the exclusive
7140 upper bound on the relocations for REL's section. */
7142 static bfd_boolean
7143 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (bfd *abfd,
7144 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
7145 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend,
7146 bfd_byte *contents, bfd_vma *addend)
7148 unsigned int r_type, lo16_type;
7149 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7150 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7151 bfd_vma l;
7153 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7154 if (mips16_reloc_p (r_type))
7155 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7156 else
7157 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7159 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend, left-shifted by
7160 sixteen bits, and the LO16 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the
7161 code does a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of the
7162 LO16 value.)
7164 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7166 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must
7167 be immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
7168 relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
7169 relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
7170 relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar
7171 extension in general, as that is useful for GCC.
7173 In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes the LO16 but keeps
7174 the corresponding HI16. This is strictly speaking a violation of
7175 the ABI but not immediately harmful. */
7176 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (abfd, lo16_type, rel, relend);
7177 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7178 return FALSE;
7180 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
7181 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, lo16_type, FALSE);
7182 l = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, lo16_relocation, lo16_howto, contents);
7184 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7185 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7187 *addend <<= 16;
7188 *addend += l;
7189 return TRUE;
7192 /* Try to read the contents of section SEC in bfd ABFD. Return true and
7193 store the contents in *CONTENTS on success. Assume that *CONTENTS
7194 already holds the contents if it is nonull on entry. */
7196 static bfd_boolean
7197 mips_elf_get_section_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_byte **contents)
7199 if (*contents)
7200 return TRUE;
7202 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
7203 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
7205 *contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
7206 return TRUE;
7209 return bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, contents);
7212 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
7213 allocate space in the global offset table. */
7215 bfd_boolean
7216 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7217 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
7219 const char *name;
7220 bfd *dynobj;
7221 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7222 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7223 size_t extsymoff;
7224 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7225 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
7226 asection *sreloc;
7227 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7228 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7229 bfd_byte *contents;
7230 bfd_vma addend;
7231 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7233 if (info->relocatable)
7234 return TRUE;
7236 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7237 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
7239 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7240 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7241 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
7242 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7244 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7245 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7247 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
7249 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
7250 if (FN_STUB_P (name))
7252 unsigned long r_symndx;
7254 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
7255 this is for. */
7257 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (sec, relocs, rel_end);
7258 if (r_symndx == 0)
7260 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7261 (_("%B: Warning: cannot determine the target function for"
7262 " stub section `%s'"),
7263 abfd, name);
7264 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7265 return FALSE;
7268 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
7269 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
7271 asection *o;
7273 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
7274 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
7275 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
7276 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
7278 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
7279 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
7281 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
7282 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
7283 || o->reloc_count == 0
7284 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
7285 continue;
7287 sec_relocs
7288 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
7289 info->keep_memory);
7290 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
7291 return FALSE;
7293 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
7294 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
7295 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
7296 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info)))
7297 break;
7299 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
7300 free (sec_relocs);
7302 if (r < rend)
7303 break;
7306 if (o == NULL)
7308 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
7309 not need it. Since this function is called before
7310 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
7311 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
7312 flag. */
7313 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7314 return TRUE;
7317 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
7318 this BFD. */
7319 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
7321 unsigned long symcount;
7322 asection **n;
7323 bfd_size_type amt;
7325 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
7326 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
7327 else
7328 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7329 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
7330 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7331 if (n == NULL)
7332 return FALSE;
7333 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
7336 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7337 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
7339 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
7340 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
7341 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
7342 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
7344 else
7346 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7348 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
7349 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
7351 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7352 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
7353 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
7355 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
7357 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
7358 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
7359 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
7360 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
7361 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
7362 if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
7364 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7365 return TRUE;
7368 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7369 h->fn_stub = sec;
7370 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
7373 else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
7375 unsigned long r_symndx;
7376 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7377 asection **loc;
7379 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
7380 this is for. */
7382 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (sec, relocs, rel_end);
7383 if (r_symndx == 0)
7385 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7386 (_("%B: Warning: cannot determine the target function for"
7387 " stub section `%s'"),
7388 abfd, name);
7389 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7390 return FALSE;
7393 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
7394 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
7396 asection *o;
7398 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
7399 needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
7400 that refers to this symbol. */
7401 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
7403 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
7404 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
7406 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
7407 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
7408 || o->reloc_count == 0
7409 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
7410 continue;
7412 sec_relocs
7413 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
7414 info->keep_memory);
7415 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
7416 return FALSE;
7418 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
7419 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
7420 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
7421 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
7422 break;
7424 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
7425 free (sec_relocs);
7427 if (r < rend)
7428 break;
7431 if (o == NULL)
7433 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
7434 not need it. Since this function is called before
7435 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
7436 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
7437 flag. */
7438 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7439 return TRUE;
7442 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
7443 this BFD. */
7444 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
7446 unsigned long symcount;
7447 asection **n;
7448 bfd_size_type amt;
7450 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
7451 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
7452 else
7453 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7454 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
7455 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7456 if (n == NULL)
7457 return FALSE;
7458 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
7461 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7462 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
7464 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
7465 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
7466 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
7467 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
7469 else
7471 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
7472 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
7474 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
7476 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
7477 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
7478 else
7479 loc = &h->call_stub;
7481 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
7482 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
7483 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
7484 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
7485 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
7486 if (*loc != NULL)
7488 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7489 return TRUE;
7492 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
7493 *loc = sec;
7494 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
7498 sreloc = NULL;
7499 contents = NULL;
7500 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
7502 unsigned long r_symndx;
7503 unsigned int r_type;
7504 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7505 bfd_boolean can_make_dynamic_p;
7507 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
7508 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
7510 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
7511 h = NULL;
7512 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
7514 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7515 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
7516 abfd, name);
7517 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7518 return FALSE;
7520 else
7522 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
7523 while (h != NULL
7524 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7525 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning))
7526 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
7529 /* Set CAN_MAKE_DYNAMIC_P to true if we can convert this
7530 relocation into a dynamic one. */
7531 can_make_dynamic_p = FALSE;
7532 switch (r_type)
7534 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
7535 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
7536 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
7537 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
7538 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
7539 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
7540 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
7541 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
7542 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
7543 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
7544 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
7545 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
7546 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
7547 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
7548 if (dynobj == NULL)
7549 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
7550 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info))
7551 return FALSE;
7552 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
7554 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7555 (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
7556 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
7557 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7558 return FALSE;
7560 break;
7562 /* This is just a hint; it can safely be ignored. Don't set
7563 has_static_relocs for the corresponding symbol. */
7564 case R_MIPS_JALR:
7565 break;
7567 case R_MIPS_32:
7568 case R_MIPS_REL32:
7569 case R_MIPS_64:
7570 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
7571 must be handled using copy relocs or PLT entries; it is not
7572 possible to convert this relocation into a dynamic one.
7574 For executables that use PLTs and copy-relocs, we have a
7575 choice between converting the relocation into a dynamic
7576 one or using copy relocations or PLT entries. It is
7577 usually better to do the former, unless the relocation is
7578 against a read-only section. */
7579 if ((info->shared
7580 || (h != NULL
7581 && !htab->is_vxworks
7582 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__gnu_local_gp") != 0
7583 && !(!info->nocopyreloc
7584 && !PIC_OBJECT_P (abfd)
7585 && MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))))
7586 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7588 can_make_dynamic_p = TRUE;
7589 if (dynobj == NULL)
7590 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
7591 break;
7593 /* For sections that are not SEC_ALLOC a copy reloc would be
7594 output if possible (implying questionable semantics for
7595 read-only data objects) or otherwise the final link would
7596 fail as ld.so will not process them and could not therefore
7597 handle any outstanding dynamic relocations.
7599 For such sections that are also SEC_DEBUGGING, we can avoid
7600 these problems by simply ignoring any relocs as these
7601 sections have a predefined use and we know it is safe to do
7604 This is needed in cases such as a global symbol definition
7605 in a shared library causing a common symbol from an object
7606 file to be converted to an undefined reference. If that
7607 happens, then all the relocations against this symbol from
7608 SEC_DEBUGGING sections in the object file will resolve to
7609 nil. */
7610 if ((sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
7611 break;
7612 /* Fall through. */
7614 default:
7615 /* Most static relocations require pointer equality, except
7616 for branches. */
7617 if (h)
7618 h->pointer_equality_needed = TRUE;
7619 /* Fall through. */
7621 case R_MIPS_26:
7622 case R_MIPS_PC16:
7623 case R_MIPS16_26:
7624 if (h)
7625 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_static_relocs = TRUE;
7626 break;
7629 if (h)
7631 /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
7632 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader. Allocate
7633 room for them in .rela.dyn. */
7634 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
7636 if (sreloc == NULL)
7638 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
7639 if (sreloc == NULL)
7640 return FALSE;
7642 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
7643 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
7644 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
7645 relocations against the text segment. */
7646 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7649 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
7650 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
7651 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP
7652 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type) && htab->is_vxworks))
7654 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
7655 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
7656 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
7657 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS*_GOT16 and
7658 R_MIPS*_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
7659 always evaluate to "G". We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
7660 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
7661 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
7662 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
7663 rel->r_addend, info, 0))
7664 return FALSE;
7667 if (h != NULL && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (abfd, r_type))
7668 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
7670 switch (r_type)
7672 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
7673 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
7674 if (h == NULL)
7676 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7677 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
7678 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
7679 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7680 return FALSE;
7682 /* Fall through. */
7684 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
7685 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
7686 if (h != NULL)
7688 /* Make sure there is room in the regular GOT to hold the
7689 function's address. We may eliminate it in favour of
7690 a .got.plt entry later; see mips_elf_count_got_symbols. */
7691 if (!mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, TRUE, 0))
7692 return FALSE;
7694 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
7695 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
7696 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
7697 h->needs_plt = 1;
7698 h->type = STT_FUNC;
7700 break;
7702 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
7703 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
7704 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
7705 if (h)
7707 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
7708 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7710 /* This symbol is definitely not overridable. */
7711 if (hmips->root.def_regular
7712 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
7713 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
7714 h = NULL;
7716 /* Fall through. */
7718 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
7719 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
7720 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
7721 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
7722 if (!h || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE)
7724 /* This relocation needs (or may need, if h != NULL) a
7725 page entry in the GOT. For R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE we do not
7726 know for sure until we know whether the symbol is
7727 preemptible. */
7728 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (abfd, sec, relocs, rel))
7730 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
7731 return FALSE;
7732 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
7733 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, rel,
7734 howto, contents);
7735 if (got16_reloc_p (r_type))
7736 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (abfd, rel, rel_end,
7737 contents, &addend);
7738 else
7739 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
7741 else
7742 addend = rel->r_addend;
7743 if (!mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (info, abfd, r_symndx,
7744 addend))
7745 return FALSE;
7746 break;
7748 /* Fall through. */
7750 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
7751 if (h && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
7752 FALSE, 0))
7753 return FALSE;
7754 break;
7756 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
7757 if (info->shared)
7758 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
7759 /* Fall through */
7761 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
7762 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
7764 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7765 h = NULL;
7767 /* Fall through */
7769 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
7770 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
7771 for TLS GD relocations. */
7773 unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
7774 ? GOT_TLS_GD
7775 : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
7776 ? GOT_TLS_LDM
7777 : GOT_TLS_IE);
7778 if (h != NULL)
7780 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
7781 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7782 hmips->tls_type |= flag;
7784 if (h && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
7785 FALSE, flag))
7786 return FALSE;
7788 else
7790 BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != STN_UNDEF);
7792 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
7793 rel->r_addend,
7794 info, flag))
7795 return FALSE;
7798 break;
7800 case R_MIPS_32:
7801 case R_MIPS_REL32:
7802 case R_MIPS_64:
7803 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
7804 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
7805 no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation. */
7806 if (can_make_dynamic_p)
7808 if (sreloc == NULL)
7810 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
7811 if (sreloc == NULL)
7812 return FALSE;
7814 if (info->shared && h == NULL)
7816 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
7817 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
7818 relocs. Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn. */
7819 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
7820 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
7821 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
7822 relocations against the text segment. */
7823 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7825 else
7827 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7829 /* For a shared object, we must copy this relocation
7830 unless the symbol turns out to be undefined and
7831 weak with non-default visibility, in which case
7832 it will be left as zero.
7834 We could elide R_MIPS_REL32 for locally binding symbols
7835 in shared libraries, but do not yet do so.
7837 For an executable, we only need to copy this
7838 reloc if the symbol is defined in a dynamic
7839 object. */
7840 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7841 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
7842 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
7843 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
7844 are relocations against the text segment. */
7845 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
7849 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7850 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
7851 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
7852 break;
7854 case R_MIPS_26:
7855 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
7856 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
7857 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
7858 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7859 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
7860 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
7861 break;
7863 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
7864 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
7865 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7866 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
7867 return FALSE;
7868 break;
7870 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
7871 used. Record for later use during GC. */
7872 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
7873 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
7874 if (h != NULL
7875 && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
7876 return FALSE;
7877 break;
7879 default:
7880 break;
7883 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
7884 related to taking the function's address. This doesn't apply to
7885 VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer to a .got.plt entry instead of
7886 a normal .got entry. */
7887 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h != NULL)
7888 switch (r_type)
7890 default:
7891 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
7892 break;
7893 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
7894 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
7895 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
7896 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
7897 case R_MIPS_JALR:
7898 break;
7901 /* See if this reloc would need to refer to a MIPS16 hard-float stub,
7902 if there is one. We only need to handle global symbols here;
7903 we decide whether to keep or delete stubs for local symbols
7904 when processing the stub's relocations. */
7905 if (h != NULL
7906 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (r_type)
7907 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (sec))
7909 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
7911 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7912 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
7915 /* Refuse some position-dependent relocations when creating a
7916 shared library. Do not refuse R_MIPS_32 / R_MIPS_64; they're
7917 not PIC, but we can create dynamic relocations and the result
7918 will be fine. Also do not refuse R_MIPS_LO16, which can be
7919 combined with R_MIPS_GOT16. */
7920 if (info->shared)
7922 switch (r_type)
7924 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
7925 case R_MIPS_HI16:
7926 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
7927 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
7928 /* Don't refuse a high part relocation if it's against
7929 no symbol (e.g. part of a compound relocation). */
7930 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
7931 break;
7933 /* R_MIPS_HI16 against _gp_disp is used for $gp setup,
7934 and has a special meaning. */
7935 if (!NEWABI_P (abfd) && h != NULL
7936 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_gp_disp") == 0)
7937 break;
7939 /* Likewise __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__ on VxWorks. */
7940 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
7941 break;
7943 /* FALLTHROUGH */
7945 case R_MIPS16_26:
7946 case R_MIPS_26:
7947 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
7948 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7949 (_("%B: relocation %s against `%s' can not be used when making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC"),
7950 abfd, howto->name,
7951 (h) ? h->root.root.string : "a local symbol");
7952 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7953 return FALSE;
7954 default:
7955 break;
7960 return TRUE;
7963 bfd_boolean
7964 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
7965 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
7966 bfd_boolean *again)
7968 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
7969 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
7970 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7971 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
7972 size_t extsymoff;
7973 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
7974 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
7975 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
7977 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
7978 *again = FALSE;
7980 if (link_info->relocatable)
7981 return TRUE;
7983 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
7984 link_info->keep_memory);
7985 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
7986 return TRUE;
7988 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
7989 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7990 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7991 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7993 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
7995 bfd_vma symval;
7996 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
7997 unsigned int r_type;
7998 unsigned long r_symndx;
7999 asection *sym_sec;
8000 unsigned long instruction;
8002 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
8003 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
8004 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
8005 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
8006 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
8007 continue;
8009 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
8010 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
8011 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
8013 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
8014 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
8015 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
8017 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8018 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8019 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
8021 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
8022 skip it. */
8023 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
8024 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
8025 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
8026 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
8027 && !h->root.forced_local))
8028 continue;
8030 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
8031 if (sym_sec->output_section)
8032 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
8033 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
8034 + sym_sec->output_offset);
8035 else
8036 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
8038 else
8040 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
8042 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
8043 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
8045 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
8046 if (isymbuf == NULL)
8047 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
8048 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
8049 NULL, NULL, NULL);
8050 if (isymbuf == NULL)
8051 goto relax_return;
8054 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
8055 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
8056 continue;
8057 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
8058 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
8059 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
8060 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
8061 else
8062 sym_sec
8063 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
8064 symval = isym->st_value
8065 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
8066 + sym_sec->output_offset;
8069 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
8070 branch target. */
8071 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
8072 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
8074 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
8075 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
8076 continue;
8078 sym_offset >>= 2;
8080 /* Check that it's in range. */
8081 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
8082 continue;
8084 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
8085 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
8086 goto relax_return;
8088 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
8090 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
8091 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
8092 instruction = 0x04110000;
8093 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
8094 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
8095 instruction = 0x10000000;
8096 else
8097 continue;
8099 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
8100 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
8101 changed_contents = TRUE;
8104 if (contents != NULL
8105 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
8107 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
8108 free (contents);
8109 else
8111 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
8112 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
8115 return TRUE;
8117 relax_return:
8118 if (contents != NULL
8119 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
8120 free (contents);
8121 return FALSE;
8124 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
8126 static bfd_boolean
8127 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
8129 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
8130 bfd *dynobj;
8131 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8132 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8134 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8135 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8137 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8138 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8140 /* VxWorks executables are handled elsewhere; we only need to
8141 allocate relocations in shared objects. */
8142 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
8143 return TRUE;
8145 /* Ignore indirect and warning symbols. All relocations against
8146 such symbols will be redirected to the target symbol. */
8147 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8148 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8149 return TRUE;
8151 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, or we are creating
8152 a shared library, we will need to copy any R_MIPS_32 or
8153 R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output file. */
8154 if (! info->relocatable
8155 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
8156 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
8157 || !h->def_regular
8158 || info->shared))
8160 bfd_boolean do_copy = TRUE;
8162 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
8164 /* Do not copy relocations for undefined weak symbols with
8165 non-default visibility. */
8166 if (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
8167 do_copy = FALSE;
8169 /* Make sure undefined weak symbols are output as a dynamic
8170 symbol in PIEs. */
8171 else if (h->dynindx == -1 && !h->forced_local)
8173 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
8174 return FALSE;
8178 if (do_copy)
8180 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for this symbol,
8181 the SVR4 psABI requires it to have a dynamic symbol table
8182 index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are dynamic
8183 relocations against it.
8185 VxWorks does not enforce the same mapping between the GOT
8186 and the symbol table, so the same requirement does not
8187 apply there. */
8188 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
8190 if (hmips->global_got_area > GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
8191 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
8192 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
8195 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
8196 (dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
8197 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
8198 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
8199 against the text segment. */
8200 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8204 return TRUE;
8207 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
8208 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
8209 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
8210 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
8211 understand. */
8213 bfd_boolean
8214 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
8215 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
8217 bfd *dynobj;
8218 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
8219 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8221 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8222 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8224 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8225 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8227 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
8228 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
8229 && (h->needs_plt
8230 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
8231 || (h->def_dynamic
8232 && h->ref_regular
8233 && !h->def_regular)));
8235 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8237 /* If there are call relocations against an externally-defined symbol,
8238 see whether we can create a MIPS lazy-binding stub for it. We can
8239 only do this if all references to the function are through call
8240 relocations, and in that case, the traditional lazy-binding stubs
8241 are much more efficient than PLT entries.
8243 Traditional stubs are only available on SVR4 psABI-based systems;
8244 VxWorks always uses PLTs instead. */
8245 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
8247 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8248 return TRUE;
8250 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
8251 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
8252 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
8253 executable and the shared library. */
8254 if (!h->def_regular)
8256 hmips->needs_lazy_stub = TRUE;
8257 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
8258 return TRUE;
8261 /* As above, VxWorks requires PLT entries for externally-defined
8262 functions that are only accessed through call relocations.
8264 Both VxWorks and non-VxWorks targets also need PLT entries if there
8265 are static-only relocations against an externally-defined function.
8266 This can technically occur for shared libraries if there are
8267 branches to the symbol, although it is unlikely that this will be
8268 used in practice due to the short ranges involved. It can occur
8269 for any relative or absolute relocation in executables; in that
8270 case, the PLT entry becomes the function's canonical address. */
8271 else if (((h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
8272 || (h->type == STT_FUNC && hmips->has_static_relocs))
8273 && htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs
8274 && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8275 && !(ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
8276 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
8278 /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, allocate room
8279 for the header. */
8280 if (htab->splt->size == 0)
8282 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sgotplt->size == 0);
8284 /* If we're using the PLT additions to the psABI, each PLT
8285 entry is 16 bytes and the PLT0 entry is 32 bytes.
8286 Encourage better cache usage by aligning. We do this
8287 lazily to avoid pessimizing traditional objects. */
8288 if (!htab->is_vxworks
8289 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->splt, 5))
8290 return FALSE;
8292 /* Make sure that .got.plt is word-aligned. We do this lazily
8293 for the same reason as above. */
8294 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->sgotplt,
8295 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
8296 return FALSE;
8298 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
8300 /* On non-VxWorks targets, the first two entries in .got.plt
8301 are reserved. */
8302 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
8303 htab->sgotplt->size += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj);
8305 /* On VxWorks, also allocate room for the header's
8306 .rela.plt.unloaded entries. */
8307 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
8308 htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8311 /* Assign the next .plt entry to this symbol. */
8312 h->plt.offset = htab->splt->size;
8313 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
8315 /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
8316 symbol's value to the address of the stub. */
8317 if (!info->shared && !h->def_regular)
8319 h->root.u.def.section = htab->splt;
8320 h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
8321 /* For VxWorks, point at the PLT load stub rather than the
8322 lazy resolution stub; this stub will become the canonical
8323 function address. */
8324 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8325 h->root.u.def.value += 8;
8328 /* Make room for the .got.plt entry and the R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT
8329 relocation. */
8330 htab->sgotplt->size += MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj);
8331 htab->srelplt->size += (htab->is_vxworks
8332 ? MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj)
8333 : MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj));
8335 /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations. */
8336 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
8337 htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8339 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
8340 dynamic will now refer to the PLT entry instead. */
8341 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
8343 return TRUE;
8346 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
8347 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
8348 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
8349 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
8351 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
8352 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
8353 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
8354 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
8355 return TRUE;
8358 /* Otherwise, there is nothing further to do for symbols defined
8359 in regular objects. */
8360 if (h->def_regular)
8361 return TRUE;
8363 /* There's also nothing more to do if we'll convert all relocations
8364 against this symbol into dynamic relocations. */
8365 if (!hmips->has_static_relocs)
8366 return TRUE;
8368 /* We're now relying on copy relocations. Complain if we have
8369 some that we can't convert. */
8370 if (!htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs || info->shared)
8372 (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("non-dynamic relocations refer to "
8373 "dynamic symbol %s"),
8374 h->root.root.string);
8375 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8376 return FALSE;
8379 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
8380 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
8381 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
8382 object will contain position independent code, so all references
8383 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
8384 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
8385 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
8386 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
8387 same memory location for the variable. */
8389 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
8391 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8392 htab->srelbss->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8393 else
8394 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
8395 h->needs_copy = 1;
8398 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
8399 dynamic will now refer to the local copy instead. */
8400 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
8402 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, htab->sdynbss);
8405 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
8406 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
8407 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
8409 bfd_boolean
8410 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8411 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8413 asection *ri;
8414 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8415 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
8417 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8418 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8420 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
8421 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
8422 if (ri != NULL)
8423 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
8425 hti.info = info;
8426 hti.output_bfd = output_bfd;
8427 hti.error = FALSE;
8428 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
8429 mips_elf_check_symbols, &hti);
8430 if (hti.error)
8431 return FALSE;
8433 return TRUE;
8436 /* If the link uses a GOT, lay it out and work out its size. */
8438 static bfd_boolean
8439 mips_elf_lay_out_got (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8441 bfd *dynobj;
8442 asection *s;
8443 struct mips_got_info *g;
8444 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
8445 bfd_size_type page_gotno;
8446 bfd *sub;
8447 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
8448 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8450 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8451 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8453 s = htab->sgot;
8454 if (s == NULL)
8455 return TRUE;
8457 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8458 g = htab->got_info;
8460 /* Allocate room for the reserved entries. VxWorks always reserves
8461 3 entries; other objects only reserve 2 entries. */
8462 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == 0);
8463 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8464 htab->reserved_gotno = 3;
8465 else
8466 htab->reserved_gotno = 2;
8467 g->local_gotno += htab->reserved_gotno;
8468 g->assigned_gotno = htab->reserved_gotno;
8470 /* Replace entries for indirect and warning symbols with entries for
8471 the target symbol. */
8472 if (!mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g))
8473 return FALSE;
8475 /* Count the number of GOT symbols. */
8476 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_count_got_symbols, info);
8478 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
8479 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
8480 required. */
8481 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
8483 asection *subsection;
8485 for (subsection = sub->sections;
8486 subsection;
8487 subsection = subsection->next)
8489 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
8490 continue;
8491 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
8492 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
8496 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8497 /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS*_GOT16
8498 relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
8499 not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE. */
8500 page_gotno = 0;
8501 else
8502 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
8503 sections. Is 5 enough? */
8504 page_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
8506 /* Choose the smaller of the two estimates; both are intended to be
8507 conservative. */
8508 if (page_gotno > g->page_gotno)
8509 page_gotno = g->page_gotno;
8511 g->local_gotno += page_gotno;
8512 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8513 s->size += g->global_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8515 /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
8516 instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
8517 entries for one global symbol from multiple input files. */
8518 count_tls_arg.info = info;
8519 count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
8520 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
8521 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
8522 &count_tls_arg);
8523 g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
8524 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8526 /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs. It initializes $gp to
8527 __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
8528 dynamic loader. */
8529 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8531 /* VxWorks executables do not need a GOT. */
8532 if (info->shared)
8534 /* Each VxWorks GOT entry needs an explicit relocation. */
8535 unsigned int count;
8537 count = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
8538 if (count)
8539 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, count);
8542 else if (s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
8544 if (!mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, s, page_gotno))
8545 return FALSE;
8547 else
8549 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
8551 /* Set up TLS entries. */
8552 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
8553 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
8555 /* Allocate room for the TLS relocations. */
8556 arg.info = info;
8557 arg.needed = 0;
8558 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs, &arg);
8559 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
8560 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
8561 &arg);
8562 if (arg.needed)
8563 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, arg.needed);
8566 return TRUE;
8569 /* Estimate the size of the .MIPS.stubs section. */
8571 static void
8572 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8574 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8575 bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
8577 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8578 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8580 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
8581 return;
8583 /* IRIX rld assumes that a function stub isn't at the end of the .text
8584 section, so add a dummy entry to the end. */
8585 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
8587 /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
8588 At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
8589 and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
8590 be needed. */
8591 dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
8592 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
8594 /* Determine the size of one stub entry. */
8595 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
8596 ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
8597 : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
8599 htab->sstubs->size = htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size;
8602 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to the
8603 MIPS hash table. If H needs a traditional MIPS lazy-binding stub,
8604 allocate an entry in the stubs section. */
8606 static bfd_boolean
8607 mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void **data)
8609 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8611 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) data;
8612 if (h->needs_lazy_stub)
8614 h->root.root.u.def.section = htab->sstubs;
8615 h->root.root.u.def.value = htab->sstubs->size;
8616 h->root.plt.offset = htab->sstubs->size;
8617 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
8619 return TRUE;
8622 /* Allocate offsets in the stubs section to each symbol that needs one.
8623 Set the final size of the .MIPS.stub section. */
8625 static void
8626 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
8628 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8630 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8631 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8633 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
8634 return;
8636 htab->sstubs->size = 0;
8637 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub, htab);
8638 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
8639 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size
8640 == htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size);
8643 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
8645 bfd_boolean
8646 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8647 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8649 bfd *dynobj;
8650 asection *s, *sreldyn;
8651 bfd_boolean reltext;
8652 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8654 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8655 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8656 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8657 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
8659 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8661 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
8662 if (info->executable)
8664 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
8665 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8666 s->size
8667 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
8668 s->contents
8669 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
8672 /* Create a symbol for the PLT, if we know that we are using it. */
8673 if (htab->splt && htab->splt->size > 0 && htab->root.hplt == NULL)
8675 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8677 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
8679 h = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (dynobj, info, htab->splt,
8680 "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_");
8681 htab->root.hplt = h;
8682 if (h == NULL)
8683 return FALSE;
8684 h->type = STT_FUNC;
8688 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
8689 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->root, allocate_dynrelocs, (PTR) info);
8691 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (output_bfd, info);
8693 if (!mips_elf_lay_out_got (output_bfd, info))
8694 return FALSE;
8696 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (info);
8698 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
8699 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
8700 memory for them. */
8701 reltext = FALSE;
8702 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8704 const char *name;
8706 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
8707 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
8708 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
8710 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
8711 continue;
8713 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
8715 if (s->size != 0)
8717 const char *outname;
8718 asection *target;
8720 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
8721 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
8722 If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
8723 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
8724 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
8725 not. */
8726 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
8727 s->output_section);
8728 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
8729 if ((target != NULL
8730 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
8731 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
8732 || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
8733 reltext = TRUE;
8735 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
8736 to copy relocs into the output file. */
8737 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
8738 s->reloc_count = 0;
8740 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
8741 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
8742 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
8743 will move them around between input sections'
8744 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
8745 broken, so don't let it run. */
8746 info->combreloc = 0;
8749 else if (! info->shared
8750 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8751 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
8753 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
8754 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
8755 s->size += 4;
8757 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
8758 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
8759 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
8760 else if (s == htab->splt)
8762 /* If the last PLT entry has a branch delay slot, allocate
8763 room for an extra nop to fill the delay slot. This is
8764 for CPUs without load interlocking. */
8765 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd)
8766 && ! htab->is_vxworks && s->size > 0)
8767 s->size += 4;
8769 else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
8770 && s != htab->sgot
8771 && s != htab->sgotplt
8772 && s != htab->sstubs
8773 && s != htab->sdynbss)
8775 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
8776 continue;
8779 if (s->size == 0)
8781 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8782 continue;
8785 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
8786 continue;
8788 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
8789 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
8790 if (s->contents == NULL)
8792 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8793 return FALSE;
8797 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8799 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
8800 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
8801 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
8802 the .dynamic section. */
8804 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
8805 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. This must come first because glibc
8806 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and GDB only
8807 looks at the first one it sees. */
8808 if (!info->shared
8809 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
8810 return FALSE;
8812 /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
8813 used by the debugger. */
8814 if (info->executable
8815 && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
8816 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
8817 return FALSE;
8819 if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
8820 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8822 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
8824 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
8825 return FALSE;
8827 /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag. It will be set again if we
8828 write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
8829 at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
8830 absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative. */
8831 info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
8834 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
8835 return FALSE;
8837 sreldyn = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8838 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8840 /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn. It does not
8841 use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags. */
8842 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0)
8844 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
8845 return FALSE;
8847 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
8848 return FALSE;
8850 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
8851 return FALSE;
8854 else
8856 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0)
8858 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
8859 return FALSE;
8861 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
8862 return FALSE;
8864 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
8865 return FALSE;
8868 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
8869 return FALSE;
8871 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
8872 return FALSE;
8874 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
8875 return FALSE;
8877 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
8878 return FALSE;
8880 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
8881 return FALSE;
8883 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
8884 return FALSE;
8886 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
8887 return FALSE;
8889 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
8890 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
8891 return FALSE;
8893 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
8894 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
8895 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
8896 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
8897 return FALSE;
8899 if (htab->splt->size > 0)
8901 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
8902 return FALSE;
8904 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
8905 return FALSE;
8907 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
8908 return FALSE;
8910 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_PLTGOT, 0))
8911 return FALSE;
8913 if (htab->is_vxworks
8914 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
8915 return FALSE;
8918 return TRUE;
8921 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
8922 Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
8923 LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
8924 and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes. */
8926 static void
8927 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
8928 bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
8929 asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
8931 unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
8932 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
8933 asection *sec;
8935 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
8937 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
8938 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
8939 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
8940 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
8941 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
8943 rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
8944 rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
8947 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
8948 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
8950 /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging. */
8951 if (!info->relocatable)
8953 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
8954 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
8957 /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c. */
8958 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
8959 rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
8963 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
8965 bfd_boolean
8966 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
8967 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
8968 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
8969 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
8970 asection **local_sections)
8972 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
8973 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
8974 bfd_vma addend = 0;
8975 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
8976 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8978 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
8979 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
8980 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
8982 const char *name;
8983 bfd_vma value = 0;
8984 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8985 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p;
8986 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
8987 REL relocation. */
8988 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
8989 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
8990 const char *msg;
8991 unsigned long r_symndx;
8992 asection *sec;
8993 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8994 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8995 bfd_boolean rel_reloc;
8997 rel_reloc = (NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
8998 && mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
8999 relocs, rel));
9000 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
9001 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
9003 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
9004 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
9005 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
9007 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
9008 h = NULL;
9010 else
9012 unsigned long extsymoff;
9014 extsymoff = 0;
9015 if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
9016 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9017 h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
9018 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
9019 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
9020 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
9022 sec = NULL;
9023 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9024 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
9025 sec = h->root.u.def.section;
9028 if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
9029 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION (info, input_bfd, input_section,
9030 rel, relend, howto, contents);
9032 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
9034 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
9035 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
9036 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
9037 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
9038 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
9039 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
9040 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
9042 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
9043 of the reloc. */
9044 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9045 rel->r_offset += 4;
9048 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
9050 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
9051 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
9052 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
9053 RELA relocation. */
9054 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
9055 relocs, rel))
9057 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
9058 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel,
9059 howto, contents);
9060 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
9061 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type)
9062 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
9063 local_sections)))
9065 if (!mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel, relend,
9066 contents, &addend))
9068 if (h)
9069 name = h->root.root.string;
9070 else
9071 name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
9072 local_syms + r_symndx,
9073 sec);
9074 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9075 (_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
9076 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
9077 rel->r_offset);
9080 else
9081 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
9083 else
9084 addend = rel->r_addend;
9085 mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
9086 local_syms, local_sections, rel);
9089 if (info->relocatable)
9091 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
9092 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9093 rel->r_offset -= 4;
9095 if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
9097 addend += rel->r_addend;
9098 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type))
9099 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
9100 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
9101 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
9102 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
9103 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
9104 else
9105 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
9107 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
9108 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
9109 source of the addend in the final link. */
9110 addend &= howto->src_mask;
9112 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
9113 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
9114 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
9115 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
9116 but for endianness. */
9118 bfd_vma sign_bits;
9119 bfd_vma low_bits;
9120 bfd_vma high_bits;
9122 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
9123 #ifdef BFD64
9124 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
9125 #else
9126 sign_bits = -1;
9127 #endif
9128 else
9129 sign_bits = 0;
9131 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
9132 do two separate stores. */
9133 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9135 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
9136 first. */
9137 low_bits = sign_bits;
9138 high_bits = addend;
9140 else
9142 low_bits = addend;
9143 high_bits = sign_bits;
9145 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
9146 contents + rel->r_offset);
9147 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
9148 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
9149 continue;
9152 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
9153 input_bfd, input_section,
9154 contents, FALSE))
9155 return FALSE;
9158 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
9159 continue;
9162 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
9163 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
9164 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
9165 for the next. */
9166 if (rel + 1 < relend
9167 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
9168 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
9169 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
9170 else
9171 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
9173 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
9174 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
9175 input_section, info, rel,
9176 addend, howto, local_syms,
9177 local_sections, &value,
9178 &name, &cross_mode_jump_p,
9179 use_saved_addend_p))
9181 case bfd_reloc_continue:
9182 /* There's nothing to do. */
9183 continue;
9185 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
9186 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
9187 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
9188 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
9189 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
9190 continue;
9192 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
9193 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
9194 info->callbacks->warning
9195 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9196 return FALSE;
9198 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
9199 if (use_saved_addend_p)
9200 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
9201 a given location. */
9203 else
9205 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9207 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9208 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9209 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
9210 if (!htab->small_data_overflow_reported
9211 && (gprel16_reloc_p (howto->type)
9212 || howto->type == R_MIPS_LITERAL))
9214 msg = _("small-data section exceeds 64KB;"
9215 " lower small-data size limit (see option -G)");
9217 htab->small_data_overflow_reported = TRUE;
9218 (*info->callbacks->einfo) ("%P: %s\n", msg);
9220 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
9221 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
9222 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
9223 return FALSE;
9225 break;
9227 case bfd_reloc_ok:
9228 break;
9230 default:
9231 abort ();
9232 break;
9235 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
9236 until we reach the last one. */
9237 if (use_saved_addend_p)
9239 addend = value;
9240 continue;
9243 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
9244 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
9245 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
9246 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
9247 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
9248 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
9249 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
9250 only a 32-bit VMA. */
9252 bfd_vma sign_bits;
9253 bfd_vma low_bits;
9254 bfd_vma high_bits;
9256 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
9257 #ifdef BFD64
9258 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
9259 #else
9260 sign_bits = -1;
9261 #endif
9262 else
9263 sign_bits = 0;
9265 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
9266 do two separate stores. */
9267 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
9269 /* Undo what we did above. */
9270 rel->r_offset -= 4;
9271 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
9272 first. */
9273 low_bits = sign_bits;
9274 high_bits = value;
9276 else
9278 low_bits = value;
9279 high_bits = sign_bits;
9281 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
9282 contents + rel->r_offset);
9283 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
9284 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
9285 continue;
9288 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
9289 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
9290 input_bfd, input_section,
9291 contents, cross_mode_jump_p))
9292 return FALSE;
9295 return TRUE;
9298 /* A function that iterates over each entry in la25_stubs and fills
9299 in the code for each one. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info. */
9301 static int
9302 mips_elf_create_la25_stub (void **slot, void *data)
9304 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
9305 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9306 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub;
9307 asection *s;
9308 bfd_byte *loc;
9309 bfd_vma offset, target, target_high, target_low;
9311 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
9312 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
9313 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (hti->info);
9314 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9316 /* Create the section contents, if we haven't already. */
9317 s = stub->stub_section;
9318 loc = s->contents;
9319 if (loc == NULL)
9321 loc = bfd_malloc (s->size);
9322 if (loc == NULL)
9324 hti->error = TRUE;
9325 return FALSE;
9327 s->contents = loc;
9330 /* Work out where in the section this stub should go. */
9331 offset = stub->offset;
9333 /* Work out the target address. */
9334 target = (stub->h->root.root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
9335 + stub->h->root.root.u.def.section->output_offset
9336 + stub->h->root.root.u.def.value);
9337 target_high = ((target + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
9338 target_low = (target & 0xffff);
9340 if (stub->stub_section != htab->strampoline)
9342 /* This is a simple LUI/ADIDU stub. Zero out the beginning
9343 of the section and write the two instructions at the end. */
9344 memset (loc, 0, offset);
9345 loc += offset;
9346 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
9347 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 4);
9349 else
9351 /* This is trampoline. */
9352 loc += offset;
9353 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
9354 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_J (target), loc + 4);
9355 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 8);
9356 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, 0, loc + 12);
9358 return TRUE;
9361 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
9362 adjust it appropriately now. */
9364 static void
9365 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9366 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9368 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
9369 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
9370 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
9371 "_ftext",
9372 "_etext",
9373 "__dso_displacement",
9374 "__elf_header",
9375 "__program_header_table",
9376 NULL
9379 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
9380 "_fdata",
9381 "_edata",
9382 "_end",
9383 "_fbss",
9384 NULL
9387 const char* const *p;
9388 int i;
9390 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9391 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
9393 ++p)
9394 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
9396 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
9397 IRIX6 linker. */
9398 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
9399 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
9401 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
9402 if (i == 0)
9403 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
9404 else
9405 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
9407 break;
9411 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9412 dynamic sections here. */
9414 bfd_boolean
9415 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9416 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9417 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9418 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9420 bfd *dynobj;
9421 asection *sgot;
9422 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
9423 const char *name;
9424 int idx;
9425 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9426 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
9428 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9429 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9430 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9431 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9433 BFD_ASSERT (!htab->is_vxworks);
9435 if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE && hmips->no_fn_stub)
9437 /* We've decided to create a PLT entry for this symbol. */
9438 bfd_byte *loc;
9439 bfd_vma header_address, plt_index, got_address;
9440 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low, load;
9441 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9443 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
9444 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9445 BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
9446 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
9447 BFD_ASSERT (!h->def_regular);
9449 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
9450 header_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
9451 + htab->splt->output_offset);
9453 /* Calculate the index of the entry. */
9454 plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
9455 / htab->plt_entry_size);
9457 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
9458 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
9459 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
9460 + (2 + plt_index) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9461 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
9462 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
9464 /* Initially point the .got.plt entry at the PLT header. */
9465 loc = (htab->sgotplt->contents
9466 + (2 + plt_index) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9467 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9468 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
9469 else
9470 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
9472 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
9473 loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
9475 /* Pick the load opcode. */
9476 load = MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD (output_bfd);
9478 /* Fill in the PLT entry itself. */
9479 plt_entry = mips_exec_plt_entry;
9480 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_address_high, loc);
9481 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_address_low | load, loc + 4);
9483 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd))
9485 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low, loc + 8);
9486 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
9488 else
9490 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 8);
9491 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
9494 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
9495 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, htab->srelplt,
9496 plt_index, h->dynindx,
9497 R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT, got_address);
9499 /* We distinguish between PLT entries and lazy-binding stubs by
9500 giving the former an st_other value of STO_MIPS_PLT. Set the
9501 flag and leave the value if there are any relocations in the
9502 binary where pointer equality matters. */
9503 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9504 if (h->pointer_equality_needed)
9505 sym->st_other = STO_MIPS_PLT;
9506 else
9507 sym->st_value = 0;
9509 else if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
9511 /* We've decided to create a lazy-binding stub. */
9512 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
9514 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
9516 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9518 BFD_ASSERT ((htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
9519 || (h->dynindx <= 0xffff));
9521 /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed. Larger values would cause
9522 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
9523 index value. */
9524 if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
9525 return FALSE;
9527 /* Fill the stub. */
9528 idx = 0;
9529 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
9530 idx += 4;
9531 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + idx);
9532 idx += 4;
9533 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
9535 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
9536 stub + idx);
9537 idx += 4;
9539 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
9540 idx += 4;
9542 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
9543 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
9544 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
9545 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
9546 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
9547 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
9548 else
9549 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
9550 stub + idx);
9552 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->sstubs->size);
9553 memcpy (htab->sstubs->contents + h->plt.offset,
9554 stub, htab->function_stub_size);
9556 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
9557 only for the referenced symbol. */
9558 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9560 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
9561 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
9562 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
9563 sym->st_value = (htab->sstubs->output_section->vma
9564 + htab->sstubs->output_offset
9565 + h->plt.offset);
9568 /* If we have a MIPS16 function with a stub, the dynamic symbol must
9569 refer to the stub, since only the stub uses the standard calling
9570 conventions. */
9571 if (h->dynindx != -1 && hmips->fn_stub != NULL)
9573 BFD_ASSERT (hmips->need_fn_stub);
9574 sym->st_value = (hmips->fn_stub->output_section->vma
9575 + hmips->fn_stub->output_offset);
9576 sym->st_size = hmips->fn_stub->size;
9577 sym->st_other = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (sym->st_other);
9580 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
9581 || h->forced_local);
9583 sgot = htab->sgot;
9584 g = htab->got_info;
9585 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
9587 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
9588 the symbols that need them. */
9589 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
9591 bfd_vma offset;
9592 bfd_vma value;
9594 value = sym->st_value;
9595 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
9596 R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
9597 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
9600 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE && g->next && h->type != STT_TLS)
9602 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
9603 bfd_vma entry;
9604 bfd_vma offset;
9606 gg = g;
9608 e.abfd = output_bfd;
9609 e.symndx = -1;
9610 e.d.h = hmips;
9611 e.tls_type = 0;
9613 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
9615 if (g->got_entries
9616 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
9617 &e)))
9619 offset = p->gotidx;
9620 if (info->shared
9621 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
9622 && p->d.h != NULL
9623 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
9624 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
9626 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
9627 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
9628 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
9629 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
9630 appropriate addend. */
9631 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
9633 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
9634 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9635 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
9636 else
9637 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
9638 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
9640 entry = 0;
9641 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
9642 (output_bfd, info, rel,
9643 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
9644 return FALSE;
9646 else
9647 entry = sym->st_value;
9648 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
9653 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
9654 name = h->root.root.string;
9655 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
9656 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
9657 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
9658 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
9659 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
9661 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
9662 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
9663 sym->st_value = 1;
9665 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
9667 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
9668 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
9669 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
9671 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
9673 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
9674 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
9676 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
9677 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
9678 sym->st_value = 0;
9679 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
9681 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
9683 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
9684 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
9685 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
9686 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
9688 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
9690 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
9691 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
9692 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
9693 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
9697 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
9698 if (h->needs_copy)
9700 asection *s;
9701 bfd_vma symval;
9703 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9704 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
9706 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9707 symval = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
9708 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
9709 + h->root.u.def.value);
9710 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, s, s->reloc_count++,
9711 h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY, symval);
9714 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
9715 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
9716 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
9718 if (! info->shared)
9720 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
9721 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
9722 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
9724 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
9725 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9726 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9727 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
9728 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
9729 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
9731 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
9732 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
9734 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
9735 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
9736 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
9737 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
9738 != NULL);
9739 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
9743 /* Keep dynamic MIPS16 symbols odd. This allows the dynamic linker to
9744 treat MIPS16 symbols like any other. */
9745 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
9747 BFD_ASSERT (sym->st_value & 1);
9748 sym->st_other -= STO_MIPS16;
9751 return TRUE;
9754 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
9756 bfd_boolean
9757 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9758 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9759 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9760 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9762 bfd *dynobj;
9763 asection *sgot;
9764 struct mips_got_info *g;
9765 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9766 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
9768 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9769 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9770 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9771 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9773 if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9775 bfd_byte *loc;
9776 bfd_vma plt_address, plt_index, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
9777 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
9778 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9780 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9781 BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
9782 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
9784 /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry. */
9785 plt_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
9786 + htab->splt->output_offset
9787 + h->plt.offset);
9789 /* Calculate the index of the entry. */
9790 plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
9791 / htab->plt_entry_size);
9793 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
9794 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
9795 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
9796 + plt_index * 4);
9798 /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
9799 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9800 got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
9802 /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
9803 entry. The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt. */
9804 branch_offset = -(h->plt.offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
9806 /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry. */
9807 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
9808 htab->sgotplt->contents + plt_index * 4);
9810 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
9811 loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
9813 if (info->shared)
9815 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
9816 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
9817 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
9819 else
9821 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
9823 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
9824 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
9825 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
9827 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
9828 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
9829 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
9830 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
9831 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
9832 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
9833 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
9834 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
9836 loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
9837 + (plt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9839 /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry. */
9840 rel.r_offset = got_address;
9841 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
9842 rel.r_addend = h->plt.offset;
9843 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
9845 /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>). */
9846 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9847 rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
9848 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
9849 rel.r_addend = got_offset;
9850 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
9852 /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>). */
9853 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9854 rel.r_offset += 4;
9855 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
9856 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
9859 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
9860 loc = htab->srelplt->contents + plt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9861 rel.r_offset = got_address;
9862 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
9863 rel.r_addend = 0;
9864 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
9866 if (!h->def_regular)
9867 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9870 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
9872 sgot = htab->sgot;
9873 g = htab->got_info;
9874 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
9876 /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT. */
9877 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
9879 bfd_vma offset;
9880 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
9881 bfd_byte *loc;
9882 asection *s;
9884 /* Install the symbol value in the GOT. */
9885 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
9886 R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
9887 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
9889 /* Add a dynamic relocation for it. */
9890 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9891 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9892 outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
9893 + sgot->output_offset
9894 + offset);
9895 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
9896 outrel.r_addend = 0;
9897 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
9900 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
9901 if (h->needs_copy)
9903 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
9905 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9907 rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
9908 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
9909 + h->root.u.def.value);
9910 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
9911 rel.r_addend = 0;
9912 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel,
9913 htab->srelbss->contents
9914 + (htab->srelbss->reloc_count
9915 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
9916 ++htab->srelbss->reloc_count;
9919 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
9920 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
9921 sym->st_value &= ~1;
9923 return TRUE;
9926 /* Write out a plt0 entry to the beginning of .plt. */
9928 static void
9929 mips_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9931 bfd_byte *loc;
9932 bfd_vma gotplt_value, gotplt_value_high, gotplt_value_low;
9933 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9934 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9936 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9937 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9939 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9940 plt_entry = mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry;
9941 else if (ABI_N32_P (output_bfd))
9942 plt_entry = mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry;
9943 else
9944 plt_entry = mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry;
9946 /* Calculate the value of .got.plt. */
9947 gotplt_value = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
9948 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset);
9949 gotplt_value_high = ((gotplt_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
9950 gotplt_value_low = gotplt_value & 0xffff;
9952 /* The PLT sequence is not safe for N64 if .got.plt's address can
9953 not be loaded in two instructions. */
9954 BFD_ASSERT ((gotplt_value & ~(bfd_vma) 0x7fffffff) == 0
9955 || ~(gotplt_value | 0x7fffffff) == 0);
9957 /* Install the PLT header. */
9958 loc = htab->splt->contents;
9959 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | gotplt_value_high, loc);
9960 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 4);
9961 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 8);
9962 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
9963 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
9964 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
9965 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
9966 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
9969 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
9970 contents of .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9972 static void
9973 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9975 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9976 bfd_byte *loc;
9977 bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
9978 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9979 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9981 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9982 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9984 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
9986 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9987 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
9988 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
9989 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
9991 got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
9992 got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
9994 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
9995 plt_address = htab->splt->output_section->vma + htab->splt->output_offset;
9997 /* Install the PLT header. */
9998 loc = htab->splt->contents;
9999 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
10000 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
10001 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
10002 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
10003 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
10004 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
10006 /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
10007 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10008 rela.r_offset = plt_address;
10009 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
10010 rela.r_addend = 0;
10011 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10012 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10014 /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
10015 %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
10016 rela.r_offset += 4;
10017 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
10018 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10019 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10021 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10022 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10023 in which symbols were output. */
10024 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10026 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10028 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10029 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
10030 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10031 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10033 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10034 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
10035 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10036 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10038 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10039 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
10040 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10041 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10045 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library. */
10047 static void
10048 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10050 unsigned int i;
10051 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10053 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10054 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10056 /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte. */
10057 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
10058 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
10059 htab->splt->contents + i * 4);
10062 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
10064 bfd_boolean
10065 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
10066 struct bfd_link_info *info)
10068 bfd *dynobj;
10069 asection *sdyn;
10070 asection *sgot;
10071 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
10072 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10074 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10075 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10077 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10079 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
10081 sgot = htab->sgot;
10082 gg = htab->got_info;
10084 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10086 bfd_byte *b;
10087 int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
10089 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
10090 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
10092 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
10093 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
10095 for (b = sdyn->contents;
10096 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
10097 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
10099 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
10100 const char *name;
10101 size_t elemsize;
10102 asection *s;
10103 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
10105 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
10106 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
10108 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
10109 swap_out_p = TRUE;
10111 switch (dyn.d_tag)
10113 case DT_RELENT:
10114 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
10115 break;
10117 case DT_RELAENT:
10118 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
10119 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
10120 break;
10122 case DT_STRSZ:
10123 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
10124 dyn.d_un.d_val =
10125 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
10126 break;
10128 case DT_PLTGOT:
10129 s = htab->sgot;
10130 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10131 break;
10133 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
10134 s = htab->sgotplt;
10135 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10136 break;
10138 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
10139 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
10140 break;
10142 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
10143 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
10144 break;
10146 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
10148 time_t t;
10149 time (&t);
10150 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
10152 break;
10154 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
10155 /* XXX FIXME: */
10156 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10157 break;
10159 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
10160 /* XXX FIXME: */
10161 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10162 break;
10164 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
10165 s = output_bfd->sections;
10166 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
10167 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
10168 break;
10170 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
10171 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
10172 break;
10174 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
10175 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
10176 entry of the first external symbol that is not
10177 referenced within the same object. */
10178 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
10179 break;
10181 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
10182 if (gg->global_gotsym)
10184 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
10185 break;
10187 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
10188 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
10189 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
10191 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
10192 name = ".dynsym";
10193 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
10194 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
10195 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
10197 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
10198 break;
10200 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
10201 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
10202 break;
10204 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
10205 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
10206 break;
10208 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
10209 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
10210 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
10211 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
10212 break;
10214 case DT_RELASZ:
10215 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
10216 /* The count does not include the JUMP_SLOT relocations. */
10217 if (htab->srelplt)
10218 dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->size;
10219 break;
10221 case DT_PLTREL:
10222 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10223 if (htab->is_vxworks)
10224 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
10225 else
10226 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_REL;
10227 break;
10229 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
10230 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10231 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->size;
10232 break;
10234 case DT_JMPREL:
10235 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10236 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (htab->srelplt->output_section->vma
10237 + htab->srelplt->output_offset);
10238 break;
10240 case DT_TEXTREL:
10241 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
10242 the dynamic tag. */
10243 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
10245 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
10246 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10248 break;
10250 case DT_FLAGS:
10251 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
10252 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS. */
10253 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
10254 dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
10255 else
10256 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10257 break;
10259 default:
10260 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10261 if (htab->is_vxworks
10262 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
10263 swap_out_p = TRUE;
10264 break;
10267 if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
10268 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
10269 (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
10271 if (dyn_to_skip)
10273 dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
10274 dyn_to_skip = 0;
10278 /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag. */
10279 if (dyn_skipped > 0)
10280 memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
10283 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0
10284 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sgot->output_section))
10286 if (htab->is_vxworks)
10288 /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
10289 ".dynamic" section. The second is initialized by the
10290 loader and contains the shared library identifier.
10291 The third is also initialized by the loader and points
10292 to the lazy resolution stub. */
10293 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
10294 sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
10295 sgot->contents);
10296 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
10297 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10298 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
10299 sgot->contents
10300 + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10302 else
10304 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
10305 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
10306 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
10307 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
10308 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
10309 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10312 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
10313 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
10316 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
10317 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
10319 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
10320 bfd_vma addend = 0;
10322 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
10323 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
10325 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
10327 bfd_vma got_index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
10328 + g->next->tls_gotno;
10330 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
10331 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10332 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
10333 sgot->contents
10334 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
10336 if (! info->shared)
10337 continue;
10339 while (got_index < g->assigned_gotno)
10341 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
10342 = got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
10343 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
10344 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
10345 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
10346 0, &addend, sgot)))
10347 return FALSE;
10348 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
10353 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
10354 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
10355 here. */
10357 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10359 bfd_byte *b;
10360 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
10362 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
10364 for (b = sdyn->contents;
10365 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
10366 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
10368 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
10369 asection *s;
10371 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
10372 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
10374 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
10375 swap_out_p = TRUE;
10377 switch (dyn.d_tag)
10379 case DT_RELSZ:
10380 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
10381 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
10382 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
10383 are trailing null entries. */
10384 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10385 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
10386 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
10387 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
10388 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
10389 /* Adjust the section size too. Tools like the prelinker
10390 can reasonably expect the values to the same. */
10391 elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
10392 = dyn.d_un.d_val;
10393 break;
10395 default:
10396 swap_out_p = FALSE;
10397 break;
10400 if (swap_out_p)
10401 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
10402 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
10407 asection *s;
10408 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
10410 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
10412 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
10413 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
10414 if (s != NULL)
10416 cpt.id1 = 1;
10417 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
10418 cpt.id2 = 2;
10419 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
10420 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
10421 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
10422 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
10423 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
10424 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
10425 s->contents));
10427 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
10428 if (htab->sstubs != NULL)
10430 file_ptr dummy_offset;
10432 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
10433 dummy_offset = htab->sstubs->size - htab->function_stub_size;
10434 memset (htab->sstubs->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
10435 htab->function_stub_size);
10440 /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
10441 increasing order of r_symndx. The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
10442 this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
10443 relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful. */
10444 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
10446 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10447 if (s != NULL
10448 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
10450 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
10452 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
10453 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
10454 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
10455 sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
10456 else
10457 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
10458 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
10459 sort_dynamic_relocs);
10464 if (htab->splt && htab->splt->size > 0)
10466 if (htab->is_vxworks)
10468 if (info->shared)
10469 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
10470 else
10471 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
10473 else
10475 BFD_ASSERT (!info->shared);
10476 mips_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
10479 return TRUE;
10483 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
10485 static void
10486 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
10488 flagword val;
10490 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
10492 default:
10493 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
10494 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
10495 break;
10497 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
10498 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
10499 break;
10501 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
10502 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
10503 break;
10505 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
10506 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
10507 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
10508 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
10509 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
10510 break;
10512 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
10513 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
10514 break;
10516 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
10517 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
10518 break;
10520 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
10521 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
10522 break;
10524 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
10525 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
10526 break;
10528 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
10529 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
10530 break;
10532 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
10533 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
10534 break;
10536 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
10537 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
10538 break;
10540 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
10541 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
10542 break;
10544 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
10545 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
10546 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
10547 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
10548 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
10549 case bfd_mach_mips14000:
10550 case bfd_mach_mips16000:
10551 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
10552 break;
10554 case bfd_mach_mips5:
10555 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
10556 break;
10558 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e:
10559 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E;
10560 break;
10562 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f:
10563 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F;
10564 break;
10566 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
10567 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
10568 break;
10570 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a:
10571 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A;
10572 break;
10574 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
10575 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
10576 break;
10578 case bfd_mach_mips_xlr:
10579 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_XLR;
10580 break;
10582 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
10583 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
10584 break;
10586 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
10587 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
10588 break;
10590 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
10591 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
10592 break;
10594 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
10595 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
10596 break;
10598 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
10599 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
10604 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
10605 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
10606 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
10608 void
10609 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
10610 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10612 unsigned int i;
10613 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
10614 const char *name;
10615 asection *sec;
10617 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
10618 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
10619 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
10620 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
10621 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
10623 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
10624 info for each special section. */
10625 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
10626 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
10627 i++, hdrpp++)
10629 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
10631 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
10632 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
10633 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
10634 if (sec != NULL)
10635 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
10636 break;
10638 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
10639 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
10640 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
10641 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
10642 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
10643 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
10644 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
10645 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
10646 break;
10648 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
10649 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
10650 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
10651 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
10652 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
10653 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
10654 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
10655 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
10656 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
10657 break;
10659 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
10660 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
10661 if (sec != NULL)
10662 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
10663 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
10664 if (sec != NULL)
10665 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
10666 break;
10668 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
10669 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
10670 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
10671 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
10672 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
10673 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
10674 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
10675 else
10677 BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
10678 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
10679 (name
10680 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
10682 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
10683 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
10684 break;
10690 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
10691 segments. */
10694 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
10695 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10697 asection *s;
10698 int ret = 0;
10700 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
10701 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
10702 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
10703 ++ret;
10705 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
10706 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
10707 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
10708 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
10709 ++ret;
10711 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
10712 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
10713 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
10714 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
10715 ++ret;
10717 /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects. See
10718 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details. */
10719 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
10720 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
10721 ++ret;
10723 return ret;
10726 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
10728 bfd_boolean
10729 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
10730 struct bfd_link_info *info)
10732 asection *s;
10733 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
10734 bfd_size_type amt;
10736 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
10737 segment. */
10738 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
10739 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
10741 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
10742 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
10743 break;
10744 if (m == NULL)
10746 amt = sizeof *m;
10747 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
10748 if (m == NULL)
10749 return FALSE;
10751 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
10752 m->count = 1;
10753 m->sections[0] = s;
10755 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
10756 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
10757 while (*pm != NULL
10758 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
10759 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
10760 pm = &(*pm)->next;
10762 m->next = *pm;
10763 *pm = m;
10767 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
10768 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
10769 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
10770 table. */
10771 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
10772 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
10773 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
10774 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
10775 now. */
10776 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
10778 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
10779 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
10780 break;
10782 if (s)
10784 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
10786 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
10787 while (*pm != NULL
10788 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
10789 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
10790 pm = &(*pm)->next;
10792 if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
10794 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
10795 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
10796 options_segment->next = *pm;
10797 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
10798 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
10799 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
10800 options_segment->count = 1;
10801 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
10802 *pm = options_segment;
10806 else
10808 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
10810 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
10811 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
10812 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
10813 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
10814 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
10816 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
10817 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
10818 break;
10819 if (m == NULL)
10821 amt = sizeof *m;
10822 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
10823 if (m == NULL)
10824 return FALSE;
10826 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
10828 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10829 if (s == NULL)
10831 m->count = 0;
10832 m->p_flags = 0;
10833 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
10835 else
10837 m->count = 1;
10838 m->sections[0] = s;
10841 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
10842 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
10843 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
10844 pm = &(*pm)->next;
10845 if (*pm != NULL)
10846 pm = &(*pm)->next;
10848 m->next = *pm;
10849 *pm = m;
10853 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
10854 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
10855 between. */
10856 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
10857 pm = &(*pm)->next)
10858 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
10859 break;
10860 m = *pm;
10861 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
10863 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
10864 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
10865 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
10866 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
10867 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
10869 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
10870 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
10873 /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
10874 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
10875 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
10876 arrays of that size. An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
10877 be actively harmful in such cases. Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
10878 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
10879 which might move one of the other sections to a different
10880 PT_LOAD segment. */
10881 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
10882 && m != NULL
10883 && m->count == 1
10884 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
10886 static const char *sec_names[] =
10888 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
10890 bfd_vma low, high;
10891 unsigned int i, c;
10892 struct elf_segment_map *n;
10894 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
10895 high = 0;
10896 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
10898 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
10899 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
10901 bfd_size_type sz;
10903 if (low > s->vma)
10904 low = s->vma;
10905 sz = s->size;
10906 if (high < s->vma + sz)
10907 high = s->vma + sz;
10911 c = 0;
10912 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
10913 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
10914 && s->vma >= low
10915 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
10916 ++c;
10918 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
10919 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
10920 if (n == NULL)
10921 return FALSE;
10922 *n = *m;
10923 n->count = c;
10925 i = 0;
10926 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
10928 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
10929 && s->vma >= low
10930 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
10932 n->sections[i] = s;
10933 ++i;
10937 *pm = n;
10941 /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
10942 like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
10944 If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
10945 standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
10946 the new (writable) segment. However, the MIPS ABI requires
10947 .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
10948 start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
10950 Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
10951 writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
10952 header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
10953 There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
10954 so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
10955 extension.
10957 If INFO is NULL, we may be copying an already prelinked binary
10958 with objcopy or strip, so do not add this header. */
10959 if (info != NULL
10960 && !SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
10961 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
10963 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
10964 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
10965 break;
10966 if (*pm == NULL)
10968 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
10969 if (m == NULL)
10970 return FALSE;
10972 m->p_type = PT_NULL;
10973 *pm = m;
10977 return TRUE;
10980 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
10981 relocation. */
10983 asection *
10984 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
10985 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10986 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10987 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
10988 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
10990 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
10992 if (h != NULL)
10993 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
10995 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
10996 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
10997 return NULL;
11000 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
11003 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
11005 bfd_boolean
11006 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11007 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11008 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11009 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11011 #if 0
11012 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
11013 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
11014 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
11015 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
11016 unsigned long r_symndx;
11017 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11019 if (info->relocatable)
11020 return TRUE;
11022 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
11023 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
11024 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
11026 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
11027 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
11028 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
11030 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
11031 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
11032 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
11033 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
11034 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
11035 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
11036 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
11037 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
11038 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
11039 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
11040 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
11041 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
11042 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
11043 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
11044 break;
11046 default:
11047 break;
11049 #endif
11051 return TRUE;
11054 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
11055 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
11056 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
11057 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
11059 void
11060 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
11061 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
11062 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
11064 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
11066 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
11068 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
11069 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
11070 /* Any absolute non-dynamic relocations against an indirect or weak
11071 definition will be against the target symbol. */
11072 if (indmips->has_static_relocs)
11073 dirmips->has_static_relocs = TRUE;
11075 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
11076 return;
11078 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
11079 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
11080 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
11081 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
11082 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
11083 if (indmips->fn_stub)
11085 dirmips->fn_stub = indmips->fn_stub;
11086 indmips->fn_stub = NULL;
11088 if (indmips->need_fn_stub)
11090 dirmips->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
11091 indmips->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
11093 if (indmips->call_stub)
11095 dirmips->call_stub = indmips->call_stub;
11096 indmips->call_stub = NULL;
11098 if (indmips->call_fp_stub)
11100 dirmips->call_fp_stub = indmips->call_fp_stub;
11101 indmips->call_fp_stub = NULL;
11103 if (indmips->global_got_area < dirmips->global_got_area)
11104 dirmips->global_got_area = indmips->global_got_area;
11105 if (indmips->global_got_area < GGA_NONE)
11106 indmips->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
11107 if (indmips->has_nonpic_branches)
11108 dirmips->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
11110 if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
11111 dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
11114 #define PDR_SIZE 32
11116 bfd_boolean
11117 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
11118 struct bfd_link_info *info)
11120 asection *o;
11121 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
11122 unsigned char *tdata;
11123 size_t i, skip;
11125 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
11126 if (! o)
11127 return FALSE;
11128 if (o->size == 0)
11129 return FALSE;
11130 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
11131 return FALSE;
11132 if (o->output_section != NULL
11133 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
11134 return FALSE;
11136 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
11137 if (! tdata)
11138 return FALSE;
11140 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
11141 info->keep_memory);
11142 if (!cookie->rels)
11144 free (tdata);
11145 return FALSE;
11148 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
11149 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
11151 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
11153 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
11155 tdata[i] = 1;
11156 skip ++;
11160 if (skip != 0)
11162 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
11163 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
11164 ret = TRUE;
11166 else
11167 free (tdata);
11169 if (! info->keep_memory)
11170 free (cookie->rels);
11172 return ret;
11175 bfd_boolean
11176 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
11178 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
11179 return TRUE;
11180 return FALSE;
11183 bfd_boolean
11184 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
11185 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11186 asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
11188 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
11189 int i;
11191 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
11192 return FALSE;
11194 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
11195 return FALSE;
11197 to = contents;
11198 end = contents + sec->size;
11199 for (from = contents, i = 0;
11200 from < end;
11201 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
11203 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
11204 continue;
11205 if (to != from)
11206 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
11207 to += PDR_SIZE;
11209 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
11210 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
11211 return TRUE;
11214 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
11215 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
11217 struct mips_elf_find_line
11219 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
11220 struct ecoff_find_line i;
11223 bfd_boolean
11224 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
11225 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
11226 const char **filename_ptr,
11227 const char **functionname_ptr,
11228 unsigned int *line_ptr)
11230 asection *msec;
11232 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
11233 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11234 line_ptr))
11235 return TRUE;
11237 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
11238 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11239 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
11240 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
11241 return TRUE;
11243 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
11244 if (msec != NULL)
11246 flagword origflags;
11247 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
11248 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
11249 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
11251 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
11252 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
11253 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
11254 origflags = msec->flags;
11255 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
11256 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
11258 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
11259 if (fi == NULL)
11261 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
11262 char *fraw_src;
11263 char *fraw_end;
11264 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
11265 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
11267 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11268 if (fi == NULL)
11270 msec->flags = origflags;
11271 return FALSE;
11274 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
11276 msec->flags = origflags;
11277 return FALSE;
11280 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
11281 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
11282 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
11283 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
11285 msec->flags = origflags;
11286 return FALSE;
11288 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
11289 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
11290 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
11291 fraw_end = (fraw_src
11292 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
11293 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
11294 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
11296 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
11298 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
11299 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
11300 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
11301 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
11302 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
11303 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
11306 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
11307 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11308 line_ptr))
11310 msec->flags = origflags;
11311 return TRUE;
11314 msec->flags = origflags;
11317 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
11319 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
11320 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
11321 line_ptr);
11324 bfd_boolean
11325 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
11326 const char **filename_ptr,
11327 const char **functionname_ptr,
11328 unsigned int *line_ptr)
11330 bfd_boolean found;
11331 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
11332 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
11333 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
11334 return found;
11338 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
11339 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
11340 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
11342 bfd_boolean
11343 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
11344 const void *location,
11345 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
11347 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
11349 bfd_byte *c;
11351 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
11353 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
11354 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
11355 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
11356 return FALSE;
11358 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
11359 if (c == NULL)
11361 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
11362 if (c == NULL)
11363 return FALSE;
11364 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
11367 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
11370 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
11371 count);
11374 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
11375 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
11377 bfd_byte *
11378 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
11379 (bfd *abfd,
11380 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
11381 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
11382 bfd_byte *data,
11383 bfd_boolean relocatable,
11384 asymbol **symbols)
11386 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
11387 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
11388 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
11389 bfd_size_type sz;
11391 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
11392 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
11393 long reloc_count;
11395 if (reloc_size < 0)
11396 goto error_return;
11398 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
11399 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
11400 goto error_return;
11402 /* read in the section */
11403 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
11404 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
11405 goto error_return;
11407 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
11408 input_section,
11409 reloc_vector,
11410 symbols);
11411 if (reloc_count < 0)
11412 goto error_return;
11414 if (reloc_count > 0)
11416 arelent **parent;
11417 /* for mips */
11418 int gp_found;
11419 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
11422 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
11423 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
11424 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
11425 if (abfd && input_bfd
11426 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
11427 lh = 0;
11428 else
11430 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
11431 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
11433 lookup:
11434 if (lh)
11436 switch (lh->type)
11438 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
11439 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
11440 case bfd_link_hash_common:
11441 gp_found = 0;
11442 break;
11443 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
11444 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
11445 gp_found = 1;
11446 gp = lh->u.def.value;
11447 break;
11448 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
11449 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
11450 lh = lh->u.i.link;
11451 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
11452 goto lookup;
11453 case bfd_link_hash_new:
11454 default:
11455 abort ();
11458 else
11459 gp_found = 0;
11461 /* end mips */
11462 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
11464 char *error_message = NULL;
11465 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
11467 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
11468 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
11469 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
11471 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
11472 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
11473 to the generic handling. */
11474 if (gp_found
11475 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
11476 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
11477 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
11478 input_section, relocatable,
11479 data, gp);
11480 else
11481 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
11482 input_section,
11483 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
11484 &error_message);
11486 if (relocatable)
11488 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
11490 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
11491 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
11492 os->reloc_count++;
11495 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
11497 switch (r)
11499 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
11500 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
11501 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
11502 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
11503 goto error_return;
11504 break;
11505 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
11506 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
11507 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
11508 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
11509 (*parent)->address)))
11510 goto error_return;
11511 break;
11512 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
11513 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
11514 (link_info, NULL,
11515 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
11516 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
11517 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
11518 goto error_return;
11519 break;
11520 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
11521 default:
11522 abort ();
11523 break;
11529 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
11530 free (reloc_vector);
11531 return data;
11533 error_return:
11534 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
11535 free (reloc_vector);
11536 return NULL;
11539 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
11541 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
11542 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
11544 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
11545 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
11547 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
11548 if (ret == NULL)
11549 return NULL;
11551 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
11552 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
11553 sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry),
11554 MIPS_ELF_DATA))
11556 free (ret);
11557 return NULL;
11560 #if 0
11561 /* We no longer use this. */
11562 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
11563 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
11564 #endif
11565 ret->procedure_count = 0;
11566 ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
11567 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
11568 ret->rld_value = 0;
11569 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
11570 ret->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = FALSE;
11571 ret->is_vxworks = FALSE;
11572 ret->small_data_overflow_reported = FALSE;
11573 ret->srelbss = NULL;
11574 ret->sdynbss = NULL;
11575 ret->srelplt = NULL;
11576 ret->srelplt2 = NULL;
11577 ret->sgotplt = NULL;
11578 ret->splt = NULL;
11579 ret->sstubs = NULL;
11580 ret->sgot = NULL;
11581 ret->got_info = NULL;
11582 ret->plt_header_size = 0;
11583 ret->plt_entry_size = 0;
11584 ret->lazy_stub_count = 0;
11585 ret->function_stub_size = 0;
11586 ret->strampoline = NULL;
11587 ret->la25_stubs = NULL;
11588 ret->add_stub_section = NULL;
11590 return &ret->root.root;
11593 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks. */
11595 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
11596 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
11598 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
11600 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
11601 if (ret)
11603 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11605 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
11606 htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
11607 htab->is_vxworks = TRUE;
11609 return ret;
11612 /* A function that the linker calls if we are allowed to use PLTs
11613 and copy relocs. */
11615 void
11616 _bfd_mips_elf_use_plts_and_copy_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
11618 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
11621 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
11622 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
11623 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
11625 bfd_boolean
11626 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
11628 asection *o;
11629 struct bfd_link_order *p;
11630 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
11631 asection *rtproc_sec;
11632 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
11633 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
11634 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
11635 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11636 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
11637 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
11638 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
11639 asection *s;
11640 EXTR esym;
11641 unsigned int i;
11642 bfd_size_type amt;
11643 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11645 static const char * const secname[] =
11647 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
11648 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
11650 static const int sc[] =
11652 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
11653 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
11656 /* Sort the dynamic symbols so that those with GOT entries come after
11657 those without. */
11658 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11659 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11661 if (!mips_elf_sort_hash_table (abfd, info))
11662 return FALSE;
11664 /* Create any scheduled LA25 stubs. */
11665 hti.info = info;
11666 hti.output_bfd = abfd;
11667 hti.error = FALSE;
11668 htab_traverse (htab->la25_stubs, mips_elf_create_la25_stub, &hti);
11669 if (hti.error)
11670 return FALSE;
11672 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
11673 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
11675 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
11677 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
11678 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
11679 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
11680 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
11681 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
11682 else if (htab->is_vxworks
11683 && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
11684 "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
11685 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
11686 && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
11687 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
11688 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
11689 + h->u.def.value);
11690 else if (info->relocatable)
11692 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
11694 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
11695 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
11696 if (o->vma < lo
11697 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
11698 lo = o->vma;
11700 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
11701 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
11703 else
11705 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
11706 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
11707 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
11711 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
11712 information. */
11713 reginfo_sec = NULL;
11714 mdebug_sec = NULL;
11715 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
11716 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
11717 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
11719 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
11721 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
11723 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
11724 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
11725 the information together. */
11726 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
11728 asection *input_section;
11729 bfd *input_bfd;
11730 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
11731 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
11733 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
11735 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
11736 continue;
11737 abort ();
11740 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
11741 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
11743 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
11744 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
11745 return FALSE;
11747 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
11749 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
11750 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
11751 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
11752 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
11753 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
11755 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
11756 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
11757 finally written out. */
11759 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
11760 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
11761 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
11764 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
11765 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
11767 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
11768 matters, but someday it might). */
11769 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
11771 reginfo_sec = o;
11774 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
11776 struct extsym_info einfo;
11777 bfd_vma last;
11779 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
11780 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
11781 the information together. */
11782 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
11783 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
11784 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
11785 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
11786 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
11787 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
11788 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
11789 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
11790 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
11791 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
11792 symhdr->issMax = 0;
11793 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
11794 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
11795 symhdr->crfd = 0;
11796 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
11798 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
11799 debug_info structure. */
11800 debug.line = NULL;
11801 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
11802 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
11803 debug.external_sym = NULL;
11804 debug.external_opt = NULL;
11805 debug.external_aux = NULL;
11806 debug.ss = NULL;
11807 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
11808 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
11809 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
11810 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
11812 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
11813 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
11814 return FALSE;
11816 esym.jmptbl = 0;
11817 esym.cobol_main = 0;
11818 esym.weakext = 0;
11819 esym.reserved = 0;
11820 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
11821 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
11822 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
11823 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
11824 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
11825 last = 0;
11826 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
11828 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
11829 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
11830 if (s != NULL)
11832 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
11833 last = s->vma + s->size;
11835 else
11836 esym.asym.value = last;
11837 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
11838 secname[i], &esym))
11839 return FALSE;
11842 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
11844 asection *input_section;
11845 bfd *input_bfd;
11846 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
11847 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
11848 char *eraw_src;
11849 char *eraw_end;
11851 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
11853 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
11854 continue;
11855 abort ();
11858 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
11859 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
11861 if (!is_mips_elf (input_bfd))
11863 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
11864 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
11865 want to deal with it. */
11866 continue;
11869 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
11870 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
11872 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
11874 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
11875 read in the debugging information and set up an
11876 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
11877 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
11878 &input_debug))
11879 return FALSE;
11881 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
11882 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
11883 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
11884 return FALSE;
11886 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
11887 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
11888 the linker global hash table and save the information
11889 for the output external symbols. */
11890 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
11891 eraw_end = (eraw_src
11892 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
11893 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
11894 for (;
11895 eraw_src < eraw_end;
11896 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
11898 EXTR ext;
11899 const char *name;
11900 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11902 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
11903 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
11904 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
11905 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
11906 continue;
11908 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
11909 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
11910 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
11911 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
11912 continue;
11914 if (ext.ifd != -1)
11916 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
11917 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
11918 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
11921 h->esym = ext;
11924 /* Free up the information we just read. */
11925 free (input_debug.line);
11926 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
11927 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
11928 free (input_debug.external_sym);
11929 free (input_debug.external_opt);
11930 free (input_debug.external_aux);
11931 free (input_debug.ss);
11932 free (input_debug.ssext);
11933 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
11934 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
11935 free (input_debug.external_ext);
11937 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
11938 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
11939 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
11942 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
11944 /* Create .rtproc section. */
11945 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
11946 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
11948 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
11949 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
11951 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
11952 ".rtproc",
11953 flags);
11954 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
11955 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
11956 return FALSE;
11959 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
11960 info, rtproc_sec,
11961 &debug))
11962 return FALSE;
11965 /* Build the external symbol information. */
11966 einfo.abfd = abfd;
11967 einfo.info = info;
11968 einfo.debug = &debug;
11969 einfo.swap = swap;
11970 einfo.failed = FALSE;
11971 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
11972 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
11973 if (einfo.failed)
11974 return FALSE;
11976 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
11977 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
11979 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
11980 matters, but someday it might). */
11981 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
11983 mdebug_sec = o;
11986 if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
11988 const char *subname;
11989 unsigned int c;
11990 Elf32_gptab *tab;
11991 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
11992 unsigned int j;
11994 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
11995 information describing how the small data area would
11996 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
11997 not used in executables files. */
11998 if (! info->relocatable)
12000 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
12002 asection *input_section;
12004 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
12006 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
12007 continue;
12008 abort ();
12011 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
12013 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
12014 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
12015 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
12018 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
12019 currently matters, but someday it might). */
12020 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
12022 /* Really remove the section. */
12023 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
12024 --abfd->section_count;
12026 continue;
12029 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
12030 uninitialized data. */
12031 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
12032 gptab_data_sec = o;
12033 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
12034 gptab_bss_sec = o;
12035 else
12037 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12038 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
12039 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
12040 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
12041 return FALSE;
12044 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
12045 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
12046 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
12047 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
12048 case we must change the name of the output section. */
12049 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
12050 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
12052 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
12053 o->name = ".gptab.data";
12054 else
12055 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
12056 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
12057 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
12060 /* Set up the first entry. */
12061 c = 1;
12062 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
12063 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
12064 if (tab == NULL)
12065 return FALSE;
12066 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
12067 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
12069 /* Combine the input sections. */
12070 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
12072 asection *input_section;
12073 bfd *input_bfd;
12074 bfd_size_type size;
12075 unsigned long last;
12076 bfd_size_type gpentry;
12078 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
12080 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
12081 continue;
12082 abort ();
12085 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
12086 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
12088 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
12089 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
12090 sorted by ascending -G value. */
12091 size = input_section->size;
12092 last = 0;
12093 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
12094 gpentry < size;
12095 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
12097 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
12098 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
12099 unsigned long val;
12100 unsigned long add;
12101 bfd_boolean exact;
12102 unsigned int look;
12104 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
12105 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
12106 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
12108 free (tab);
12109 return FALSE;
12112 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
12113 &int_gptab);
12114 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
12115 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
12117 exact = FALSE;
12118 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
12120 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
12121 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
12123 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
12124 exact = TRUE;
12127 if (! exact)
12129 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
12130 unsigned int max;
12132 /* We need a new table entry. */
12133 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
12134 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
12135 if (new_tab == NULL)
12137 free (tab);
12138 return FALSE;
12140 tab = new_tab;
12141 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
12142 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
12144 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
12145 value, since that will be implied by this new
12146 value. */
12147 max = 0;
12148 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
12150 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
12151 && (max == 0
12152 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
12153 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
12154 max = look;
12156 if (max != 0)
12157 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
12158 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
12160 ++c;
12163 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
12166 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
12167 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
12168 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
12171 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
12172 if (c > 2)
12173 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
12175 /* Swap out the table. */
12176 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
12177 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
12178 if (ext_tab == NULL)
12180 free (tab);
12181 return FALSE;
12184 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
12185 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
12186 free (tab);
12188 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
12189 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
12191 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
12192 matters, but someday it might). */
12193 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
12197 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
12198 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
12199 return FALSE;
12201 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
12203 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
12205 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
12207 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
12208 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
12209 return FALSE;
12212 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
12214 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
12215 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
12216 swap, info,
12217 mdebug_sec->filepos))
12218 return FALSE;
12220 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
12223 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
12225 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
12226 gptab_data_sec->contents,
12227 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
12228 return FALSE;
12231 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
12233 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
12234 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
12235 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
12236 return FALSE;
12239 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
12241 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
12242 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
12244 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
12245 rtproc_sec->contents,
12246 0, rtproc_sec->size))
12247 return FALSE;
12251 return TRUE;
12254 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
12256 struct mips_mach_extension {
12257 unsigned long extension, base;
12261 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
12262 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
12264 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
12265 /* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
12266 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
12268 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
12269 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
12270 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
12271 { bfd_mach_mips_xlr, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
12272 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_3a, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
12274 /* MIPS V extensions. */
12275 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
12277 /* R10000 extensions. */
12278 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
12279 { bfd_mach_mips14000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
12280 { bfd_mach_mips16000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
12282 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
12283 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
12284 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
12285 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
12286 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
12287 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
12288 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
12290 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
12291 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
12292 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
12293 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
12294 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
12295 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
12297 /* VR4100 extensions. */
12298 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
12299 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
12301 /* MIPS III extensions. */
12302 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12303 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12304 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12305 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12306 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12307 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12308 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12309 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12310 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
12312 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
12313 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
12315 /* MIPS II extensions. */
12316 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
12317 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
12319 /* MIPS I extensions. */
12320 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
12321 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
12325 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
12327 static bfd_boolean
12328 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
12330 size_t i;
12332 if (extension == base)
12333 return TRUE;
12335 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
12336 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
12337 return TRUE;
12339 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
12340 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
12341 return TRUE;
12343 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
12344 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
12346 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
12347 if (extension == base)
12348 return TRUE;
12351 return FALSE;
12355 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
12357 static bfd_boolean
12358 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
12360 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
12361 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
12362 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
12363 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
12364 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
12365 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
12366 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
12370 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
12371 there are conflicting attributes. */
12372 static bfd_boolean
12373 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
12375 obj_attribute *in_attr;
12376 obj_attribute *out_attr;
12378 if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
12380 /* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
12381 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
12383 /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
12384 initialized. */
12385 elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
12387 return TRUE;
12390 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
12391 non-conflicting ones. */
12392 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
12393 out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
12394 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
12396 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
12397 if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
12398 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
12399 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
12401 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 4)
12402 _bfd_error_handler
12403 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), ibfd,
12404 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
12405 else if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 4)
12406 _bfd_error_handler
12407 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), obfd,
12408 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
12409 else
12410 switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
12412 case 1:
12413 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
12415 case 2:
12416 _bfd_error_handler
12417 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
12418 obfd, ibfd);
12419 break;
12421 case 3:
12422 _bfd_error_handler
12423 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
12424 obfd, ibfd);
12425 break;
12427 case 4:
12428 _bfd_error_handler
12429 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
12430 obfd, ibfd);
12431 break;
12433 default:
12434 abort ();
12436 break;
12438 case 2:
12439 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
12441 case 1:
12442 _bfd_error_handler
12443 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
12444 ibfd, obfd);
12445 break;
12447 case 3:
12448 _bfd_error_handler
12449 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
12450 obfd, ibfd);
12451 break;
12453 case 4:
12454 _bfd_error_handler
12455 (_("Warning: %B uses -mdouble-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
12456 obfd, ibfd);
12457 break;
12459 default:
12460 abort ();
12462 break;
12464 case 3:
12465 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
12467 case 1:
12468 case 2:
12469 case 4:
12470 _bfd_error_handler
12471 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
12472 ibfd, obfd);
12473 break;
12475 default:
12476 abort ();
12478 break;
12480 case 4:
12481 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
12483 case 1:
12484 _bfd_error_handler
12485 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
12486 ibfd, obfd);
12487 break;
12489 case 2:
12490 _bfd_error_handler
12491 (_("Warning: %B uses -mdouble-float, %B uses -mips32r2 -mfp64"),
12492 ibfd, obfd);
12493 break;
12495 case 3:
12496 _bfd_error_handler
12497 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
12498 obfd, ibfd);
12499 break;
12501 default:
12502 abort ();
12504 break;
12506 default:
12507 abort ();
12511 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
12512 _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
12514 return TRUE;
12517 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
12518 object file when linking. */
12520 bfd_boolean
12521 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
12523 flagword old_flags;
12524 flagword new_flags;
12525 bfd_boolean ok;
12526 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
12527 asection *sec;
12529 /* Check if we have the same endianess */
12530 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
12532 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12533 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
12534 ibfd);
12535 return FALSE;
12538 if (!is_mips_elf (ibfd) || !is_mips_elf (obfd))
12539 return TRUE;
12541 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
12543 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12544 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
12545 ibfd);
12546 return FALSE;
12549 if (!mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
12550 return FALSE;
12552 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
12553 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
12554 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
12556 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
12558 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
12559 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
12560 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
12561 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
12563 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
12564 && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
12565 || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
12566 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
12568 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
12569 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
12570 return FALSE;
12573 return TRUE;
12576 /* Check flag compatibility. */
12578 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
12579 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
12581 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
12582 doesn't seem to matter. */
12583 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
12584 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
12586 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
12587 just be able to ignore this. */
12588 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
12589 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
12591 /* DSOs should only be linked with CPIC code. */
12592 if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
12593 new_flags |= EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC;
12595 if (new_flags == old_flags)
12596 return TRUE;
12598 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
12599 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
12600 actually cause any incompatibility. */
12601 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
12603 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
12604 which are automatically generated by gas. Also ignore fake
12605 (s)common sections, since merely defining a common symbol does
12606 not affect compatibility. */
12607 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IS_COMMON) == 0
12608 && strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
12609 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
12610 && (sec->size != 0
12611 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
12612 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
12613 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
12615 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
12616 break;
12619 if (null_input_bfd)
12620 return TRUE;
12622 ok = TRUE;
12624 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
12625 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
12627 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12628 (_("%B: warning: linking abicalls files with non-abicalls files"),
12629 ibfd);
12630 ok = TRUE;
12633 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
12634 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
12635 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
12636 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
12638 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
12639 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
12641 /* Compare the ISAs. */
12642 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
12644 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12645 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
12646 ibfd);
12647 ok = FALSE;
12649 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
12651 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
12652 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
12654 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
12655 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
12656 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
12657 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
12658 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
12659 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
12660 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
12662 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
12663 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
12664 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
12665 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
12666 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
12667 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
12669 else
12671 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
12672 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12673 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
12674 ibfd,
12675 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
12676 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
12677 ok = FALSE;
12681 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
12682 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
12684 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
12685 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
12686 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
12687 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
12688 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
12690 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
12691 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
12692 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
12693 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
12695 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12696 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
12697 ibfd,
12698 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
12699 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
12700 ok = FALSE;
12702 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
12703 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
12706 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
12707 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
12709 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
12711 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
12712 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
12715 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
12716 if (new_flags != old_flags)
12718 (*_bfd_error_handler)
12719 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
12720 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
12721 (unsigned long) old_flags);
12722 ok = FALSE;
12725 if (! ok)
12727 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12728 return FALSE;
12731 return TRUE;
12734 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
12736 bfd_boolean
12737 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
12739 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
12740 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
12742 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
12743 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
12744 return TRUE;
12747 char *
12748 _bfd_mips_elf_get_target_dtag (bfd_vma dtag)
12750 switch (dtag)
12752 default: return "";
12753 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
12754 return "MIPS_RLD_VERSION";
12755 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
12756 return "MIPS_TIME_STAMP";
12757 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
12758 return "MIPS_ICHECKSUM";
12759 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
12760 return "MIPS_IVERSION";
12761 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
12762 return "MIPS_FLAGS";
12763 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
12764 return "MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS";
12765 case DT_MIPS_MSYM:
12766 return "MIPS_MSYM";
12767 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
12768 return "MIPS_CONFLICT";
12769 case DT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
12770 return "MIPS_LIBLIST";
12771 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
12772 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO";
12773 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICTNO:
12774 return "MIPS_CONFLICTNO";
12775 case DT_MIPS_LIBLISTNO:
12776 return "MIPS_LIBLISTNO";
12777 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
12778 return "MIPS_SYMTABNO";
12779 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
12780 return "MIPS_UNREFEXTNO";
12781 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
12782 return "MIPS_GOTSYM";
12783 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
12784 return "MIPS_HIPAGENO";
12785 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
12786 return "MIPS_RLD_MAP";
12787 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS:
12788 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS";
12789 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO:
12790 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO";
12791 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE:
12792 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE";
12793 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO:
12794 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO";
12795 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC:
12796 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC";
12797 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO:
12798 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO";
12799 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM:
12800 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM";
12801 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO:
12802 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO";
12803 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM:
12804 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM";
12805 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO:
12806 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO";
12807 case DT_MIPS_CXX_FLAGS:
12808 return "MIPS_CXX_FLAGS";
12809 case DT_MIPS_PIXIE_INIT:
12810 return "MIPS_PIXIE_INIT";
12811 case DT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
12812 return "MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB";
12813 case DT_MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX:
12814 return "MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX";
12815 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX:
12816 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX";
12817 case DT_MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX:
12818 return "MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX";
12819 case DT_MIPS_PROTECTED_GOTIDX:
12820 return "MIPS_PROTECTED_GOT_IDX";
12821 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
12822 return "MIPS_OPTIONS";
12823 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE:
12824 return "MIPS_INTERFACE";
12825 case DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN:
12826 return "DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN";
12827 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE:
12828 return "DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE";
12829 case DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR:
12830 return "DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR";
12831 case DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX:
12832 return "DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX";
12833 case DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE:
12834 return "DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE";
12835 case DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE:
12836 return "DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE";
12837 case DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC:
12838 return "DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC";
12839 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
12840 return "DT_MIPS_PLTGOT";
12841 case DT_MIPS_RWPLT:
12842 return "DT_MIPS_RWPLT";
12846 bfd_boolean
12847 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
12849 FILE *file = ptr;
12851 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
12853 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
12854 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
12856 /* xgettext:c-format */
12857 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
12859 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
12860 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
12861 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
12862 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
12863 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
12864 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
12865 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
12866 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
12867 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
12868 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
12869 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
12870 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
12871 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
12872 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
12873 else
12874 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
12876 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
12877 fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
12878 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
12879 fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
12880 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
12881 fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
12882 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
12883 fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
12884 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
12885 fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
12886 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
12887 fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
12888 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
12889 fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
12890 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
12891 fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
12892 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
12893 fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
12894 else
12895 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
12897 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
12898 fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
12900 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
12901 fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
12903 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
12904 fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
12905 else
12906 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
12908 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
12909 fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
12911 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
12912 fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
12914 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
12915 fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
12917 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
12918 fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
12920 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
12921 fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
12923 fputc ('\n', file);
12925 return TRUE;
12928 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
12930 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
12931 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
12932 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
12933 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
12934 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
12935 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"), 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
12936 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
12939 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes. Ensure that the
12940 STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
12941 definiton of the symbol. */
12942 void
12943 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
12944 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
12945 bfd_boolean definition,
12946 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12948 if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
12950 unsigned char other;
12952 other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
12953 other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
12954 h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
12957 if (!definition
12958 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
12959 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
12962 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
12963 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
12964 bfd_boolean
12965 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
12967 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
12970 bfd_boolean
12971 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
12973 return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
12974 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
12975 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
12978 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
12979 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
12981 bfd_vma
12982 _bfd_mips_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i, const asection *plt,
12983 const arelent *rel ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12985 return (plt->vma
12986 + 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
12987 + i * 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry));
12990 void
12991 _bfd_mips_post_process_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
12993 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
12994 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
12996 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
12997 if (link_info)
12999 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (link_info);
13000 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
13002 if (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs && !htab->is_vxworks)
13003 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = 1;